*** empty log message ***
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.4 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 ---
163 ** If the environment variable DISPLAY specifies an unreachable X display,
164 Emacs will now startup as if invoked with the --no-window-system option.
165
166 +++
167 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
168 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
169 an interactively callable function.
170
171 +++
172 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
173 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
174 affects the initial frame.
175
176 +++
177 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
178 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
179 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
180 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
181 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
182
183 +++
184 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
185 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
186 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
187 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
188 `inhibit-splash-screen').
189
190 +++
191 ** The default is now to use a bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
192 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
193 the bitmap icon off.
194
195 +++
196 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
197 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
198 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
199
200 +++
201 ** Init file changes
202 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
203 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
204 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
205
206 +++
207 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
208 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
209 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
210 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
211 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
212 \f
213 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
214
215 +++
216 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
217 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
218 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
219 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
220
221 +++
222 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
223 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
224
225 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
226 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
227
228 +++
229 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
230 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
231 the operating system or your X server.
232
233 +++
234 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
235
236 +++
237 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
238 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
239 you about it.
240
241 +++
242 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
243 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
244
245 +++
246 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
247 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
248 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
249 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
250
251 +++
252 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
253 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
254
255 +++
256 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
257
258 See below under "incremental search changes".
259
260 ---
261 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
262
263 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
264 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
265 directory with Dired.
266
267 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
268 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
269
270 +++
271 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
272 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
273 it remains unchanged.
274
275 +++
276 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
277 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
278 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
279 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
280 "New keymaps for typing file names".
281
282 +++
283 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
284 M-o M-o requests refontification.
285
286 +++
287 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
288
289 See below for more details.
290
291 +++
292 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
293 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
294 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
295 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
296 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
297 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
298 \f
299 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
300
301 +++
302 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
303 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
304 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
305 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
306 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
307 a new Emacs.
308
309 +++
310 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
311 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
312
313 +++
314 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
315 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
316 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
317 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
318
319 +++
320 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
321
322 +++
323 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
324 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
325
326 ---
327 ** C-x 5 C-o displays a specified buffer in another frame
328 but does not switch to that frame. It's the multi-frame
329 analogue of C-x 4 C-o.
330
331 ---
332 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
333 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
334
335 +++
336 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
337 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
338
339 +++
340 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
341 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
342 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
343 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
344
345 +++
346 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
347 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
348 in Indented-Text mode.
349
350 +++
351 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
352
353 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
354 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
355 in the value, use `$$'.
356
357 +++
358 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
359 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
360 `same-window'.
361
362 +++
363 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
364 from the locale.
365
366 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
367 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
368 only faces matching this regexp.
369
370 ** Mark command changes:
371
372 +++
373 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
374 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
375 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
376
377 +++
378 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
379
380 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
381 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
382 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
383 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
384 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
385 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
386 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
387 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
388 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
389
390 +++
391 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
392
393 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
394 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
395 paragraphs.
396
397 +++
398 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
399 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
400 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
401 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
402 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
403 command only.
404
405 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
406 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
407 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
408 mark or the region.
409
410 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
411 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
412 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
413 C-g.
414
415 +++
416 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
417 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
418 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
419
420 ** Help command changes:
421
422 +++
423 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
424
425 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
426
427 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
428
429 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
430 that do not change:
431
432 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
433 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
434
435 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
436 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
437
438 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
439 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
440 run by the key sequence.
441 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
442 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
443 that command.
444
445 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
446 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
447 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
448 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
449 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
450 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
451 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
452 new-kill-line is on C-k
453
454 ---
455 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
456 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
457 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
458 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
459
460 +++
461 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
462 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
463
464 +++
465 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
466 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
467 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
468 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
469 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
470 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
471 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
472 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
473 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
474
475 +++
476 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
477 description various information about a character, including its
478 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
479 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
480 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
481
482 +++
483 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
484 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
485
486 +++
487 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
488 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
489 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
490 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
491 keyboard oriented alternative.
492
493 +++
494 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
495 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
496 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
497 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
498 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
499
500 +++
501 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
502 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
503 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
504 available.
505
506 +++
507 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
508 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
509 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
510 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
511 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
512 matching item.
513
514 ** Incremental Search changes:
515
516 +++
517 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
518 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
519 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
520 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
521 for details.
522
523 +++
524 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
525 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
526 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
527 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
528
529 +++
530 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
531 at the end of a line.
532
533 +++
534 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
535 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
536 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
537
538 +++
539 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
540 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
541 search string used as the string to replace.
542
543 +++
544 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
545 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
546 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
547
548 ** Replace command changes:
549
550 ---
551 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
552 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
553 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
554
555 +++
556 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
557 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
558 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
559 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
560 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
561 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
562 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
563 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
564 can be edited for each replacement.
565
566 +++
567 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
568 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
569
570 ---
571 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
572 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
573
574 ** File operation changes:
575
576 +++
577 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
578 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
579 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
580 is only rarely needed.
581
582 +++
583 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
584 suffix from every line before processing all the lines.
585
586 +++
587 *** If the local variables list contains any variable-value pairs that
588 are not known to be safe, Emacs shows a prompt asking whether to apply
589 the local variables list as a whole. In earlier versions, a prompt
590 was only issued for variables explicitly marked as risky (for the
591 definition of risky variables, see `risky-local-variable-p').
592
593 At the prompt, the user can choose to save the contents of this local
594 variables list to `safe-local-variable-values'. This new customizable
595 option is a list of variable-value pairs that are known to be safe.
596 Variables can also be marked as safe with the existing
597 `safe-local-variable' property (see `safe-local-variable-p').
598 However, risky variables will not be added to
599 `safe-local-variable-values' in this way.
600
601 +++
602 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
603 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
604
605 +++
606 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
607 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
608
609 +++
610 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
611
612 ---
613 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
614
615 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
616 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
617 directory with Dired.
618
619 +++
620 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
621 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
622 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
623 file.)
624
625 +++
626 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
627 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
628
629 +++
630 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
631 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
632 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
633 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
634 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
635 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
636
637 ---
638 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
639 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
640 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
641
642 ---
643 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
644 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
645 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
646
647 +++
648 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
649 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
650 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
651 in data loss, use with care.
652
653 +++
654 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
655 Emacs asks for confirmation.
656
657 +++
658 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
659
660 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
661 when visiting the file.
662
663 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
664 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
665 when saving the file.
666
667 +++
668 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
669 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
670 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
671 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
672 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
673 modes do.
674
675 ** Minibuffer changes:
676
677 +++
678 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
679 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
680
681 +++
682 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
683 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
684 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
685 prompt string.
686
687 ---
688 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
689
690 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
691 have in common and where they begin to differ.
692
693 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
694 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
695 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
696 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
697 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
698 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
699 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
700 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
701
702 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
703 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
704 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
705 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
706 its second argument.
707
708 +++
709 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
710 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
711 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
712 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
713 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
714 candidate is a directory.
715
716 +++
717 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
718 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
719 it remains unchanged.
720
721 +++
722 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
723 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
724 elements are deleted.
725
726 ** Redisplay changes:
727
728 +++
729 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
730 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
731 appears between the position information and the major mode.
732
733 +++
734 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
735
736 +++
737 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
738 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
739 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
740
741 +++
742 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
743 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
744 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
745 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
746
747 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
748 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
749 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
750 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
751 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
752 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
753
754 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
755 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
756
757 ---
758 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller than
759 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
760 vscroll property.
761
762 +++
763 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
764 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
765 the mode line of the currently selected window.
766
767 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
768 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
769
770 +++
771 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
772 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
773 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
774 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
775 set-fringe-style.
776
777 +++
778 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
779 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
780 the window can be scrolled.
781
782 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
783 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
784 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
785
786 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
787 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
788
789 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
790 position of each bitmap individually.
791
792 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
793 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
794 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
795 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
796
797 +++
798 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
799 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
800 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
801 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
802 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
803
804 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
805 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
806
807 +++
808 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
809 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
810 outside those margins.
811
812 +++
813 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
814 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
815
816 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
817 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
818 or when the frame is resized.
819
820 ** Cursor display changes:
821
822 +++
823 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
824 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
825
826 +++
827 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
828
829 +++
830 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
831 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
832 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
833 cursor does.
834
835 +++
836 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
837 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
838 appears in.
839
840 +++
841 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
842 of the recognized cursor types.
843
844 +++
845 *** On text terminals, the variable `visible-cursor' controls whether Emacs
846 uses the "very visible" cursor (the default) or the normal cursor.
847
848 ** New faces:
849
850 +++
851 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
852 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
853 areas.
854
855 *** `mode-line-buffer-id' is the standard face for buffer identification
856 parts of the mode line.
857
858 +++
859 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
860 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
861 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
862 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
863 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
864 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
865
866 +++
867 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
868
869 ** Font-Lock changes:
870
871 +++
872 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
873 M-o M-o requests refontification.
874
875 +++
876 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
877 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
878 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
879
880 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
881 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
882 `Info-mode-hook'.
883
884 +++
885 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
886 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
887 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
888 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
889 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
890
891 +++
892 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
893
894 +++
895 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
896
897 +++
898 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
899 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
900 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
901 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
902
903 ---
904 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
905 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
906 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
907 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
908 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
909
910 ---
911 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
912
913 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
914 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
915 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
916 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
917
918 ---
919 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
920
921 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
922 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
923 refontification takes place.
924
925 ** Menu support:
926
927 ---
928 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
929 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
930 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
931 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
932 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
933 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
934
935 ---
936 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
937
938 ---
939 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
940
941 ---
942 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
943 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
944 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
945
946 +++
947 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
948 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
949
950 ---
951 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
952 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
953
954 +++
955 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
956 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
957 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
958
959 ---
960 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
961 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
962
963 +++
964 *** For the Gtk+ version, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
965 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
966 the new dialog.
967
968 ** Mouse changes:
969
970 +++
971 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
972 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
973 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
974 can be selected only when it is active.
975
976 +++
977 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
978 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
979 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
980 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
981 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
982 to give it focus.
983
984 +++
985 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
986
987 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
988 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
989 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
990 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
991 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
992 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
993
994 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
995 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
996 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
997 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
998 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
999 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1000 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1001 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1002 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1003
1004 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1005 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1006 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1007 you release it).
1008
1009 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1010 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1011
1012 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1013 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1014
1015 +++
1016 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1017 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1018 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1019 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1020 also disable mouse highlighting.
1021
1022 +++
1023 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1024 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1025 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1026
1027 ---
1028 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1029 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1030
1031 ---
1032 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1033
1034 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1035 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1036 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1037 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1038
1039 +++
1040 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1041
1042 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1043
1044 ---
1045 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1046 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1047 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1048 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1049 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1050
1051 +++
1052 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1053 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1054 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1055 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1056 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1057 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1058 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1059 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1060
1061 +++
1062 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1063 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1064
1065 +++
1066 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1067 coding system.
1068
1069 +++
1070 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1071 of a file.
1072
1073 ---
1074 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1075 unicode.
1076
1077 +++
1078 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1079 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1080 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1081 command.
1082
1083 +++
1084 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1085 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1086
1087 +++
1088 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1089 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1090 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1091 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1092 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1093 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1094 mule-unicode-... ones.
1095
1096 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1097 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1098 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1099 possible.
1100
1101 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1102 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1103 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1104 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1105 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1106
1107 ---
1108 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1109 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1110 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1111 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1112
1113 ---
1114 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1115 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1116 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1117 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1118 automatically according to the locale.)
1119
1120 ---
1121 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1122 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1123 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1124 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1125 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1126 tamil-inscript.
1127
1128 ---
1129 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1130 characters.
1131
1132 ---
1133 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1134 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1135 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1136 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1137 M-f (forward-word)
1138 M-b (backward-word)
1139 M-d (kill-word)
1140 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1141 M-t (transpose-words)
1142 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1143
1144 ---
1145 *** Indian support has been updated.
1146 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1147 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1148 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1149 supported.
1150
1151 ---
1152 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1153
1154 ---
1155 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1156 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1157 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1158 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1159 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1160 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1161 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1162 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1163 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1164 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1165 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1166 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1167
1168 ---
1169 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1170 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1171 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1172
1173 ---
1174 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1175 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1176 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1177 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1178 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1179
1180 ---
1181 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1182 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1186 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1187 fontset appropriately.
1188
1189 ** Customize changes:
1190
1191 +++
1192 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1193 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1194 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1195 enable-theme to enable a disabled theme.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1199 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1200 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1201 faces.
1202
1203 ---
1204 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1205 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1206 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1207 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1208 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1209 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1210 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1211
1212 +++
1213 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1214 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1215 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1216 under the "[State]" button.
1217
1218 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1219
1220 +++
1221 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1222 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to T in Buffer Menu
1223 mode.
1224
1225 +++
1226 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1227 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1228 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1229
1230 ---
1231 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1232 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1233 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1234
1235 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1236 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1237 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1238 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1239 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1240
1241 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1242 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1243 t, and the status is shown.
1244
1245 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1246 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1247
1248 ** Dired mode:
1249
1250 ---
1251 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1252 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1253 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1254
1255 +++
1256 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1257 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1258
1259 +++
1260 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1261 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1262
1263 +++
1264 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1265 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1266 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1267 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1268 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1269 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1270
1271 +++
1272 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1273 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1274
1275 +++
1276 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1277
1278 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1279 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1280 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1281 instead.
1282
1283 +++
1284 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1285 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1286 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1287 directory listing into a buffer.
1288
1289 ** Comint changes:
1290
1291 ---
1292 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1293 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1294 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1295 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1296 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1297
1298 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1299 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1300
1301 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1302 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1303 lines, including any prompts.
1304
1305 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1306 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1307 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1308 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1309 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1310 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1311 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1312
1313 +++
1314 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1315 modes (shell-mode, etc.) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1316 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1317 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1318
1319 +++
1320 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1321 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1322 but declared obsolete.
1323
1324 ** M-x Compile changes:
1325
1326 ---
1327 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1328
1329 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1330 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1331 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1332 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1333
1334 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1335 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1336 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1337
1338 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1339 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1340 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1341 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1342 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1343
1344 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1345
1346 +++
1347 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1348 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1349 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1350 subprocesses inherit.
1351
1352 +++
1353 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1354 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1355
1356 +++
1357 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1358 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1359 in new face `next-error'.
1360
1361 +++
1362 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1363 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1364 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1365 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1366 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1367 C-c C-f.
1368
1369 +++
1370 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1371 the compilation buffer.
1372
1373 +++
1374 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1375 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1376 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1377 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1378 of the window.
1379
1380 ** Occur mode changes:
1381
1382 +++
1383 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1384 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1385 switching to it.
1386
1387 +++
1388 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1389 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1390
1391 +++
1392 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1393 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1394 `multi-occur-in-matching-buffers' which allows you to specify the
1395 buffers to search by their filenames or buffer names. Internally,
1396 Occur mode has been rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other
1397 changes.
1398
1399 ** Grep changes:
1400
1401 +++
1402 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1403
1404 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1405 customization group.
1406
1407 ---
1408 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1409
1410 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1411 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1412
1413 +++
1414 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1415 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1416
1417 ---
1418 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1419 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1420 settings, for grep commands only.
1421
1422 +++
1423 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlights matches in *grep*
1424 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1425 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1426 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1427 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1428 source line is highlighted.
1429
1430 +++
1431 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1432 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1433 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1434 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1435 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1436 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1437 file.
1438
1439 +++
1440 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1441 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1442 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1443 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1444 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1445 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1446
1447 ** X Windows Support:
1448
1449 +++
1450 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1451 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1452 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1453
1454 +++
1455 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1456 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1457 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1458 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1459 Meta and Alt:
1460 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1461 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1462
1463 +++
1464 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1465 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1466
1467 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1468 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1469
1470 ---
1471 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1472 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1473 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1474 and use the more appropriately result.
1475
1476 ---
1477 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1478 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1479 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1480
1481 ** Xterm support:
1482
1483 ---
1484 *** If you enable Xterm Mouse mode, Emacs will respond to mouse clicks
1485 on the mode line, header line and display margin, when run in an xterm.
1486
1487 ---
1488 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1489 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1490 following should work:
1491 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1492 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1493 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1494
1495 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1496
1497 +++
1498 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1499 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1500 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1501 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1502 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1503 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1504 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1505 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1506 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1507
1508 ---
1509 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1510 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1511 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1512 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1513 all of these colors.
1514
1515 +++
1516 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1517 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1518 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1519 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1520 colors as on X.
1521
1522 ---
1523 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1524 \f
1525 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1526
1527 ** ERC is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1528
1529 ERC is a powerful, modular, and extensible IRC client for Emacs.
1530
1531 To see what modules are available, type
1532 M-x customize-option erc-modules RET.
1533
1534 To start an IRC session, type M-x erc-select, and follow the prompts
1535 for server, port, and nick.
1536
1537 ---
1538 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1539
1540 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1541 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1542 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1543 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1544 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1545 separate buffers.
1546
1547 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1548 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1549
1550 ---
1551 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1552
1553 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1554 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1555 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1556 separate manual.
1557
1558 +++
1559 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1560 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1561
1562 +++
1563 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1564 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1565 program files that include other program files.
1566
1567 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1568 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1569 in them.
1570
1571 +++
1572 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1573
1574 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1575 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1576 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1577 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1578 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1579 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1580
1581 ---
1582 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1583 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1584
1585 ---
1586 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1587
1588 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1589 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1590 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1591 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1592
1593 +++
1594 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1595 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1596
1597 ---
1598 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1599
1600 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1601 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1602 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1603 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1604 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1605 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1606
1607 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1608 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1609 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1610 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1611
1612 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1613 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1614 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1615 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1616 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1617 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1618 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1619
1620 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1621 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1622 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1623
1624 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1625 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1626
1627 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1628 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1629 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1630 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1631
1632 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1633 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1634 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1635 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1636
1637 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1638 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1639 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1640 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1641
1642 +++
1643 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1644
1645 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1646 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1647 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1648 capabilities.
1649
1650 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1651 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1652
1653 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1654 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1655 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1656
1657 +++
1658 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1659 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1660 to increment the SOA serial.
1661
1662 ---
1663 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1664 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1665 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1666 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1667 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticeable. The display method can
1668 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1669
1670 +++
1671 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1672 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1673
1674 +++
1675 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1676 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1677 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1678 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1679 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1680
1681 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1682 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1683 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1684 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1685 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1686 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1687
1688 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1689 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1690 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1691 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1692 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1693 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1694 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1695 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1696 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1697 or local keymaps.
1698
1699 +++
1700 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1701 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1702
1703 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1704 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1705 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1706 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1707
1708 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1709 defined macros.
1710
1711 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1712 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1713 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1714 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1715 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1716 for more commands.
1717
1718 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1719 the keyboard macro ring.
1720
1721 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1722 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1723
1724 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1725 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1726 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1727 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1728
1729 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1730 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1731 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1732
1733 ---
1734 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1735 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1736 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1737
1738 +++
1739 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1740 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1741
1742 +++
1743 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1744 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1745 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1746 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1747 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1748 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1749 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1750 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1751 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1752
1753 +++
1754 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1755
1756 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1757 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1758 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1759 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1760 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1761 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1762
1763 ---
1764 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1765 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1766 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1767 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1768
1769 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1770
1771 ---
1772 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1773 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1774 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1775 settings.
1776
1777 +++
1778 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1779 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1780 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1781 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1782
1783 +++
1784 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1785 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1786
1787 +++
1788 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1789 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1790 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1791 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1792 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1793 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1794
1795 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1796 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1797 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1798
1799 +++
1800 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1801
1802 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1803 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1804 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1805 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1806 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1807 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1808 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1809 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1810 `rsync' to do the copying).
1811
1812 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1813 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1814
1815 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1816
1817 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1818
1819 Removing Tramp, and re-enabling Ange-FTP, can be achieved by M-x
1820 tramp-unload-tramp.
1821
1822 ---
1823 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1824
1825 ---
1826 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1827 configuration files.
1828
1829 +++
1830 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1831 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1832 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1833 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1834 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1835 recognized.
1836
1837 ---
1838 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1839
1840 +++
1841 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1842
1843 ---
1844 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1845 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1846
1847 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1848 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1849 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1850 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1851 boundaries during scrolling.
1852 \f
1853 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1854
1855 ** Changes in Dired
1856
1857 +++
1858 *** Bindings for Tumme added
1859 Several new keybindings, all starting with the C-t prefix, have been
1860 added to Dired. They are all bound to commands in Tumme. As a starting
1861 point, mark some image files in a dired buffer and do C-t d to display
1862 thumbnails of them in a separate buffer.
1863
1864 ** Changes in Hi Lock
1865
1866 +++
1867 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1868 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1869 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1870 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1871 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1872 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1873 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1874 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1875
1876 ** Changes in Allout
1877
1878 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1879 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1880 clear-text within a single file to your heart's content, using symmetric
1881 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1882 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1883 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1884 powerful ways.
1885
1886 *** Default command prefix changed to "\C-c " (control-c space), to avoid
1887 intruding on user's keybinding space. Customize the
1888 `allout-command-prefix' variable to your preference.
1889
1890 *** Allout now uses text overlay's `invisible' property (and others) for
1891 concealed text, instead of selective-display. This simplifies the code, in
1892 particularly avoiding the need for kludges for isearch dynamic-display,
1893 discretionary handling of edits of concealed text, undo concerns, etc.
1894
1895 *** Many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1896
1897 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1898 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1899 - refuse to create "containment discontinuities", where a
1900 topic is shifted deeper than the offspring-depth of its' container
1901 - bulleting variation is simpler and more accommodating, both in the
1902 default behavior and in ability to vary when creating new topics
1903 - many internal fixes and refinements
1904 - many module and function docstring clarifications
1905 - version number incremented to 2.2
1906
1907 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1908 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1909 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1910 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1911 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1912
1913 ---
1914 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1915
1916 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1917 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1918
1919 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1920 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1921 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1922
1923 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1924 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1925 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1926 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1927 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1928
1929 ---
1930 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
1931
1932 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
1933 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1934 faces.
1935
1936 +++
1937 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1938 of the file that precede the first header line.
1939
1940 +++
1941 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1942
1943 ---
1944 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1945 run most curses applications now.
1946
1947 +++
1948 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1949
1950 +++
1951 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1952 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1953 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1954
1955 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1956 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1957 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1958
1959 ---
1960 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1961 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1962
1963 ---
1964 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1965 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1966 incompatible change.
1967
1968 ---
1969 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1970
1971 +++
1972 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1973 resync points in both windows.
1974
1975 +++
1976 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1977
1978 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1979 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1980
1981 ---
1982 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1983 when Emacs visits them.
1984
1985 ** Info mode changes:
1986
1987 +++
1988 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1989 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1990
1991 +++
1992 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1993
1994 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1995 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1996 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1997 around the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1998 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1999 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
2000 Info node.
2001
2002 ---
2003 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
2004 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
2005 search without prompting for a new search string.
2006
2007 +++
2008 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
2009 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
2010 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
2011
2012 ---
2013 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
2014
2015 ---
2016 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
2017 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
2018
2019 +++
2020 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
2021 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
2022 possible matches.
2023
2024 ---
2025 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
2026 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
2027 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
2028
2029 +++
2030 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
2031 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
2032
2033 ---
2034 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
2035 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
2036
2037 +++
2038 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
2039
2040 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
2041 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
2042
2043 ---
2044 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
2045
2046 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
2047 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
2048 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
2049
2050 +++
2051 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
2052
2053 ---
2054 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
2055
2056 ** Lisp mode changes:
2057
2058 ---
2059 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2060
2061 +++
2062 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2063
2064 *** New features in evaluation commands
2065
2066 +++
2067 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2068 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2069
2070 +++
2071 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2072 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2073 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2074 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2075 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2076
2077 +++
2078 ** CC mode changes.
2079
2080 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2081 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2082 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2083
2084 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2085 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2086
2087 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2088 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2089
2090 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2091 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2092
2093 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2094 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2095 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2096 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2097 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2098
2099 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2100
2101 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2102
2103 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2104 position(s).
2105
2106 *** New Minor Modes
2107 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2108 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2109 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2110 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2111 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2112 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2113
2114 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2115 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2116 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2117
2118 *** New clean-ups
2119
2120 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2121 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2122 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2123
2124 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2125 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2126 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2127
2128 *** Font lock support.
2129 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2130 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2131 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2132 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2133 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2134 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2135
2136 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2137 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2138 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2139 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2140 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2141 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2142 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2143 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2144 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2145
2146 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2147 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2148 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2149 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2150 minute.
2151
2152 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2153 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2154 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2155 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2156 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2157 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2158
2159 **** Support for documentation comments.
2160 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2161 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2162 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2163 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2164
2165 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2166 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2167 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2168 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2169 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2170
2171 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2172 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2173 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2174 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2175 parens.
2176
2177 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2178 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2179 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2180 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2181 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2182
2183 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2184 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2185 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2186 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2187 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2188
2189 *** Support for the AWK language.
2190 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2191 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2192 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2193 Here is a summary:
2194
2195 **** Indentation Engine
2196 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2197
2198 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2199 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2200 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2201 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2202 definition, or structured statement.
2203
2204 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2205 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2206 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2207
2208 **** Font Locking
2209 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2210 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2211 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2212 the AWK language itself.
2213
2214 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2215 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2216 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2217 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2218 extended definition.
2219
2220 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2221 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2222 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2223 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2224
2225 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2226 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2227 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2228 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2229 composition-close, and incomposition.
2230
2231 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2232 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2233 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2234 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2235 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2236
2237 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2238
2239 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2240 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2241 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2242 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2243
2244 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2245 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2246
2247 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2248
2249 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2250 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2251 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2252 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2253
2254 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2255
2256 is now analyzed as
2257
2258 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2259
2260 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2261 symbol.
2262
2263 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2264 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2265 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2266 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2267 cdr.
2268
2269 *** API changes for derived modes.
2270
2271 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2272 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2273 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2274 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2275 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2276
2277 **** New language variable system.
2278 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2279 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2280
2281 **** New initialization functions.
2282 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2283 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2284 `c-init-language-vars'.
2285
2286 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2287 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2288 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2289 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2290
2291 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2292 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2293 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2294 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2295 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2296
2297 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2298 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2299 its substatement. E.g:
2300
2301 if (x)
2302 x_is_true:
2303 do_stuff();
2304
2305 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2306
2307 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2308 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2309 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2310 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2311 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2312 inside `#define's.
2313
2314 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2315
2316 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2317 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2318 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2319 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2320 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2321 empty lines within the macro better.
2322
2323 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2324 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2325 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2326
2327 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2328 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2329 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2330 backslashes can be moved.
2331
2332 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2333 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2334 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2335 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2336
2337 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2338 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2339 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2340 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2341 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2342 backslash) in the macro.
2343
2344 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2345 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2346 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2347 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2348 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2349 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2350
2351 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2352 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2353
2354 *** New lineup functions
2355
2356 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2357 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2358 continues. E.g:
2359
2360 result = prefix + "A message "
2361 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2362
2363 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2364 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2365
2366 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2367 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2368 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2369
2370 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2371 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2372
2373 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2374 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2375
2376 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2377 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2378 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2379 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2380 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2381 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2382
2383 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2384 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2385 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2386 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2387 context.
2388
2389 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2390 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2391 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2392 happen when macros are involved.
2393
2394 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2395 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2396 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2397 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2398 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2399 line is left untouched.
2400
2401 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2402 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2403 syntactic indentation.
2404
2405 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2406 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2407
2408 ---
2409 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2410
2411 ---
2412 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2413 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2414 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2415 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2416
2417 ** Fortran mode changes:
2418
2419 ---
2420 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2421 highlighting for the old default.
2422
2423 +++
2424 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2425 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2426 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2427
2428 +++
2429 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2430 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2431 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2432 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2433
2434 ---
2435 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2436 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2437 majority.
2438
2439 ---
2440 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2441 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2442
2443 ---
2444 ** Reftex mode changes
2445
2446 +++
2447 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2448
2449 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2450 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2451 support for multifile documents.
2452
2453 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2454 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2455 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2456 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2457 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2458 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2459 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2460 with the `d' key.
2461
2462 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2463 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2464
2465 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2466 key `M-%'.
2467
2468 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2469 location.
2470
2471 +++
2472 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2473
2474 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2475 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2476 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2477
2478 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2479 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2480 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2481 citation selection buffer.
2482
2483 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2484 cursor as a default search string.
2485
2486 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2487 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2488
2489 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2490 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2491
2492 Support for jurabib has been added.
2493
2494 +++
2495 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2496
2497 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2498 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2499
2500 +++
2501 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2502
2503 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2504 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2505 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2506 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2507 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2508 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2509
2510 +++
2511 *** Miscellaneous changes
2512
2513 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2514 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2515
2516 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2517
2518 +++
2519 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2520 to support use of font-lock.
2521
2522 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2523
2524 ---
2525 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2526 automatically.
2527
2528 +++
2529 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2530 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2531 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2532 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2533 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2534 from the file name or buffer contents.
2535
2536 +++
2537 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2538
2539 ** TeX modes:
2540
2541 +++
2542 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2543
2544 +++
2545 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2546 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2547 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2548 TeX commands to use at startup.
2549
2550 ---
2551 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2552 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2553
2554 +++
2555 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2556
2557 ** BibTeX mode:
2558
2559 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2560 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2561
2562 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2563 an existing BibTeX entry by inserting fields that may occur but are not
2564 present.
2565
2566 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2567
2568 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2569 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2570 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2571 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2572 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2573 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2574
2575 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2576 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2577
2578 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2579 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2580
2581 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2582 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2583
2584 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2585 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2586
2587 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2588 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2589 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2590
2591 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2592 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2593
2594 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2595 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2596
2597 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2598 in multiple BibTeX files.
2599
2600 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2601 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2602
2603 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2604 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2605 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2606
2607 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and
2608 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to
2609 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and
2610 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are
2611 still available as aliases.
2612
2613 +++
2614 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2615 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2616 and `C-c C-r'.
2617
2618 ** GUD changes:
2619
2620 +++
2621 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2622 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2623
2624 ---
2625 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2626 and other common debugger commands.
2627
2628 +++
2629 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2630 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2631 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2632 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2633 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2634 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2635 breakpoints.
2636
2637 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2638
2639 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2640 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2641 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2642
2643 +++
2644 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2645 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2646 not executing.
2647
2648 ---
2649 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2650
2651 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class information.
2652 Fast startup since there is no need to scan all source files up front.
2653 There is also no need to create and maintain lists of source
2654 directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath' and
2655 `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2656
2657 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2658 set/clear operations from Java source files under the classpath, stack
2659 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2660 (gud-finish).
2661
2662 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2663 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2664
2665 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2666 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2667 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2668
2669 *** Added Customization Variables
2670
2671 **** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2672
2673 **** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2674 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2675 java sources (previous method).
2676
2677 **** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for Java
2678 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2679 is nil).
2680
2681 *** Minor Improvements
2682
2683 **** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2684 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2685 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2686 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2687 `starttls' tool).
2688
2689 **** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2690
2691 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2692
2693 +++
2694 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2695
2696 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2697 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2698 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2699 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2700 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2701 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2702 be mode dependent.
2703
2704 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2705 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2706 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2707 toggles this mode.
2708
2709 +++
2710 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2711 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2712 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2713 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2714 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2715 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2716 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2717 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2718 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2719
2720 +++
2721 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2722 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2723 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2724 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2725 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2726
2727 ---
2728 ** recentf changes.
2729
2730 The recent file list is now automatically cleaned up when recentf mode is
2731 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2732 automatic cleanup.
2733
2734 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2735 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2736 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2737
2738 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2739 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2740 keep in the recent list.
2741
2742 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2743 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2744 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2745 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2746 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2747
2748 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2749 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2750 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2751
2752 +++
2753 ** Desktop package
2754
2755 +++
2756 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2757
2758 +++
2759 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2760
2761 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2762
2763 ---
2764 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2765 buffer list.
2766
2767 +++
2768 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2769 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2770 idle).
2771
2772 +++
2773 *** New commands:
2774 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2775 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2776 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2777 it was loaded.
2778 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2779 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2780
2781 ---
2782 *** New customizable variables:
2783 - desktop-save. Determines whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2784 killed.
2785 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2786 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2787 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2788 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2789 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2790 should not delete.
2791 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2792 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2793 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2794 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2795
2796 +++
2797 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2798
2799 ---
2800 *** New hooks:
2801 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2802 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2803
2804 ---
2805 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2806
2807 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2808 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2809 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2810 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2811 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2812 feature.
2813
2814 ** EDiff changes.
2815
2816 +++
2817 *** When comparing directories.
2818 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2819 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2820 from one directory to another.
2821
2822 +++
2823 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2824 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2825 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2826 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2827 comparison.
2828
2829 +++
2830 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2831 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2832 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2833
2834 +++
2835 ** Etags changes.
2836
2837 *** New regular expressions features
2838
2839 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2840
2841 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2842 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2843 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2844 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2845 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2846 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2847 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2848 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2849 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2850 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2851
2852 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2853
2854 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2855 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2856 CR, TAB, VT.
2857
2858 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2859
2860 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2861 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2862 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2863
2864 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2865
2866 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2867 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2868
2869 *** New language parsing features
2870
2871 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2872
2873 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2874
2875 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2876
2877 **** New language HTML.
2878
2879 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2880 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2881
2882 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2883
2884 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2885 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2886
2887 **** New language Lua.
2888
2889 All functions are tagged.
2890
2891 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2892
2893 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2894 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2895 package::sub.
2896
2897 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2898
2899 **** New language PHP.
2900
2901 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2902 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2903
2904 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2905
2906 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2907 renewenvironment.
2908
2909 *** Honor #line directives.
2910
2911 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2912 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2913 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2914 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2915 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2916
2917 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2918
2919 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2920 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2921 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2922 the file FILE.
2923
2924 ** VC Changes
2925
2926 +++
2927 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2928 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2929
2930 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2931 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2932 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2933 `.emacs' file:
2934
2935 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2936
2937 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2938
2939 +++
2940 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2941 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2942
2943 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2944 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2945 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2946
2947 +++
2948 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2949
2950 +++
2951 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2952
2953 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2954 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2955 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2956
2957 P: annotates the previous revision
2958 N: annotates the next revision
2959 J: annotates the revision at line
2960 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2961 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2962 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2963 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2964
2965 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2966
2967 +++
2968 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2969 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2970 in the repository.
2971
2972 +++
2973 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2974 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2975 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2976 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2977
2978 +++
2979 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2980 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2981 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2982
2983 +++
2984 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2985
2986 See the documentation of the user option
2987 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2988
2989 ** Rmail changes:
2990
2991 ---
2992 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2993
2994 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2995 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2996 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2997
2998 +++
2999 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
3000
3001 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
3002 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
3003 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
3004 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
3005 used instead of the native one.
3006
3007 ** Gnus package
3008
3009 ---
3010 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
3011
3012 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
3013 PGP/MIME.
3014
3015 ---
3016 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
3017
3018 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
3019
3020 ---
3021 ** MH-E changes.
3022
3023 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.93. There have been major changes since
3024 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
3025
3026 ** Calendar changes:
3027
3028 +++
3029 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
3030 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
3031
3032 +++
3033 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
3034 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
3035
3036 +++
3037 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
3038 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
3039 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
3040 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
3041 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
3042 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
3043 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
3044 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
3045 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
3046
3047 +++
3048 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
3049 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
3050 count backward from the end of the year.
3051
3052 +++
3053 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
3054 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
3055 day of that ISO week.
3056
3057 ---
3058 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
3059 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
3060
3061 ---
3062 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
3063 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
3064 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
3065 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3066
3067 ---
3068 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3069 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3070 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3071
3072 +++
3073 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3074 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3075 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3076 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3077
3078 +++
3079 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3080 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3081 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3082 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3083 formats.
3084
3085 +++
3086 ** Speedbar changes:
3087
3088 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3089 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3090
3091 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3092 keymap.
3093
3094 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3095 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3096
3097 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3098
3099 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3100 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3101 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3102 its descendents.
3103
3104 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3105 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3106 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3107 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3108 deletion.
3109
3110 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3111 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3112 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3113 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3114 that number to `other-frame'.
3115
3116 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3117 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3118
3119 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3120 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3121 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3122 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3123 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3124 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3125 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3126 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3127 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3128
3129 ---
3130 ** sql changes.
3131
3132 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlighting of different
3133 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3134 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3135 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3136 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3137
3138 The following values are supported:
3139
3140 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3141 db2 DB2
3142 informix Informix
3143 ingres Ingres
3144 interbase Interbase
3145 linter Linter
3146 ms Microsoft
3147 mysql MySQL
3148 oracle Oracle
3149 postgres Postgres
3150 solid Solid
3151 sqlite SQLite
3152 sybase Sybase
3153
3154 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3155 SQL mode indicator.
3156
3157 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3158 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3159 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3160
3161 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3162
3163 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3164 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3165 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3166 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3167
3168 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3169 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3170
3171 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3172
3173 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3174 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3175
3176 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3177
3178 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3179 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3180 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3181 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3182 terminated.
3183
3184 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3185 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3186 credentials to authenticate the user.
3187
3188 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3189 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3190 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3191
3192 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3193 Keyword highlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3194
3195 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3196 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3197 defaults.
3198
3199 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3200 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3201 `sql-product'.
3202
3203 ---
3204 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3205
3206 ** FFAP changes:
3207
3208 +++
3209 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3210
3211 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3212 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3213 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3214 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3215
3216 ---
3217 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3218
3219 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3220 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3221
3222 ---
3223 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3224
3225 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3226 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3227 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3228 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3229 with other details of skeleton construction.
3230
3231 ---
3232 ** Hideshow mode changes
3233
3234 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3235 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3236 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3237 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3238
3239 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3240 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3241 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3242
3243 +++
3244 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3245 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3246 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3247
3248 ---
3249 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3250
3251 ---
3252 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3253 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3254 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3255 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3256
3257 ---
3258 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3259
3260 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3261 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3262 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3263
3264 ---
3265 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3266 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3267 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3268 using strokes as an input method.
3269
3270 ** Emacs server changes:
3271
3272 +++
3273 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3274
3275 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3276 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3277 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3278 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3279
3280 +++
3281 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3282 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3283 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3284
3285 +++
3286 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3287
3288 ---
3289 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3290
3291 +++
3292 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3293
3294 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3295 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3296 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3297
3298 ---
3299 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3300 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3301
3302 ---
3303 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3304
3305 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3306 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3307 inverse-video.
3308
3309 ---
3310 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3311
3312 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3313 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3314 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3315
3316 ** battery.el changes:
3317
3318 ---
3319 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3320
3321 ---
3322 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3323
3324 ---
3325 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3326
3327 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3328 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3329 byte boundaries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3330 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3331
3332 ---
3333 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3334
3335 ---
3336 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3337
3338 ---
3339 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3340 \f
3341 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3342
3343 +++
3344 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3345
3346 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3347 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3348 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3349 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3350 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3351 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3352 where USERNAME is your user name.
3353
3354 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3355 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3356 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3357
3358 +++
3359 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3360
3361 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3362 existing values. For example:
3363
3364 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3365
3366 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3367 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3368
3369 ---
3370 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3371
3372 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3373 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3374
3375 ---
3376 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3377
3378 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3379
3380 ---
3381 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3382
3383 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3384 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3385 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3386 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3387 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3388 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3389
3390 ---
3391 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3392
3393 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3394 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3395 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3396 sound support for those formats.
3397
3398 ---
3399 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3400
3401 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3402
3403 ---
3404 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3405
3406 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3407 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3408 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3409
3410 ---
3411 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3412
3413 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3414 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3415 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3416 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3417 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3418 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3419 you wish to use them in other faces.
3420
3421 ---
3422 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3423
3424 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3425 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3426 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3427 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3428 any customizations.
3429
3430 ---
3431 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3432
3433 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3434 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3435 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3436 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favors local console
3437 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3438 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3439 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3440 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3441 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3442 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3443
3444 ---
3445 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3446
3447 ---
3448 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3449 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3450 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3451
3452 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3453 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3454 \f
3455 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3456
3457 ---
3458 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3459 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3460
3461 +++
3462 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3463 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3464 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3465 `undefined'.)
3466
3467 +++
3468 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3469 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3470 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3471
3472 ---
3473 The function `comint-send-input' now accepts 3 optional arguments:
3474
3475 (comint-send-input &optional no-newline artificial)
3476
3477 Callers sending input not from the user should use bind the 3rd
3478 argument `artificial' to a non-nil value, to prevent Emacs from
3479 deleting the part of subprocess output that matches the input.
3480
3481 ---
3482 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3483
3484 +++
3485 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3486 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3487 \f
3488 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3489
3490 ** General Lisp changes:
3491
3492 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3493 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3494 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3495
3496 +++
3497 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3498
3499 +++
3500 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3501
3502 +++
3503 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3504
3505 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3506 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3507 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3508
3509 +++
3510 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3511 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3512
3513 +++
3514 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3515
3516 It recursively copies through both CARs and CDRs.
3517
3518 +++
3519 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3520
3521 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3522 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3523 first one.
3524
3525 +++
3526 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3527
3528 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3529 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3530
3531 +++
3532 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3533
3534 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3535 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3536 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3537 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3538
3539 +++
3540 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3541
3542 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3543
3544 +++
3545 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3546
3547 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3548 longer accepted.
3549
3550 +++
3551 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3552
3553 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3554 cyclic.
3555
3556 +++
3557 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3558
3559 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3560 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3561
3562 +++
3563 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3564
3565 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3566 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3567 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3568
3569 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3570 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3571
3572 +++
3573 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3574
3575 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3576 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3577 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3578
3579 +++
3580 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3581
3582 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3583 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3584 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3585
3586 +++
3587 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3588
3589 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3590 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3591 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3592 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3593
3594 +++
3595 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3596
3597 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3598 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3599 the code that has inhibited quitting exits.
3600
3601 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3602 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3603
3604 +++
3605 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3606
3607 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3608
3609 +++
3610 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3611
3612 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3613 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3614 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc.).
3615
3616 +++
3617 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3618 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3619 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3620
3621 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3622
3623 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3624
3625 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3626
3627 +++
3628 *** New function `string-or-null-p'.
3629
3630 Return t if OBJECT is a string or nil. Otherwise, return nil.
3631
3632 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3633
3634 +++
3635 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3636
3637 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3638 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3639
3640 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3641
3642 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3643 possible declaration specifiers are:
3644
3645 (indent INDENT)
3646 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3647
3648 (edebug DEBUG)
3649 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3650 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3651 but this is cleaner.)
3652
3653 ---
3654 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3655
3656 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3657
3658 ---
3659 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3660
3661 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3662 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3663 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3664 forms.
3665
3666 +++
3667 ** Variable aliases:
3668
3669 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3670
3671 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3672 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3673 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3674 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3675
3676 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3677 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3678
3679 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3680
3681 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3682 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3683 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3684
3685 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3686 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3687
3688 +++
3689 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3690 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3691
3692 ** defcustom changes:
3693
3694 +++
3695 *** The package-version keyword has been added to provide
3696 `customize-changed-options' functionality to packages in the future.
3697 Developers who make use of this keyword must also update the new
3698 variable `customize-package-emacs-version-alist'.
3699
3700 +++
3701 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3702
3703 ** String changes:
3704
3705 +++
3706 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3707
3708 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3709 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3710 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3711
3712 +++
3713 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3714
3715 +++
3716 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3717
3718 +++
3719 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3720 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3721 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3722 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3723 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3724
3725 +++
3726 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3727 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3728
3729 +++
3730 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3731 text properties.
3732
3733 +++
3734 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3735 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3736 been declared obsolete.
3737
3738 +++
3739 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3740
3741 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3742 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3743 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3744 warnings in a separate window.
3745
3746 +++
3747 ** Progress reporters.
3748
3749 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3750 progress messages for the user.
3751
3752 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3753 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3754 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3755
3756 ** Buffer positions:
3757
3758 +++
3759 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3760 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3761 the usable window height and width is used.
3762
3763 +++
3764 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3765 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3766 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3767 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3768 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3769
3770 +++
3771 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3772
3773 It defaults to 1.
3774
3775 +++
3776 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3777
3778 It defaults to 1.
3779
3780 +++
3781 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' tests if a position is in a clickable link.
3782
3783 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3784 functionality.
3785
3786 +++
3787 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3788
3789 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3790
3791 +++
3792 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3793
3794 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3795 give up and return LIMIT.
3796
3797 +++
3798 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3799 and partial visibility state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3800 arg is non-nil.
3801
3802 +++
3803 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3804 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3805 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3806
3807 ** Text modification:
3808
3809 +++
3810 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3811 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3812 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3813
3814 +++
3815 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3816 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3817 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3818
3819 +++
3820 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3821 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3822 inserted substring.
3823
3824 +++
3825 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3826 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3827 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3828 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3829 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3830
3831 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3832 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3833 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3834 text.
3835
3836 +++
3837 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3838 argument.
3839
3840 +++
3841 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3842 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3843 be inserted is translated through it.
3844
3845 ---
3846 *** Text clones.
3847
3848 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3849 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3850 clone to the other.
3851
3852 ---
3853 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3854
3855 ** Filling changes.
3856
3857 +++
3858 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3859 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3860 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3861
3862 +++
3863 ** Atomic change groups.
3864
3865 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3866 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3867 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3868
3869 (atomic-change-group
3870 (insert foo)
3871 (delete-region x y))
3872
3873 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3874 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3875 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3876 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3877
3878 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3879 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3880
3881 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3882 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3883 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3884 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3885
3886 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3887 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3888 do this.
3889
3890 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3891 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3892 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3893 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3894
3895 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3896 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3897 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3898 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3899 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3900 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3901 twice.
3902
3903 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3904 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3905 returned values, like this:
3906
3907 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3908 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3909
3910 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3911 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3912 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3913
3914 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3915 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3916 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3917 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3918 finished.
3919
3920 ** Buffer-related changes:
3921
3922 ---
3923 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3924
3925 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3926
3927 +++
3928 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3929
3930 +++
3931 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3932 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3933 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3934 value of VARIABLE instead.
3935
3936 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3937 various status records in parallel.
3938
3939 It takes a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3940 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3941 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3942 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3943 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3944 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3945 it returns nil.
3946
3947 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3948 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3949 vector into the variable and returns t.
3950
3951 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3952 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3953 purpose.
3954
3955 +++
3956 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3957 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3958 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3959 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3960
3961 ** Local variables lists:
3962
3963 +++
3964 *** Text properties in local variables.
3965
3966 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3967 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3968
3969 +++
3970 *** The variable `enable-local-variables' controls how local variable
3971 lists are handled. t, the default, specifies the standard querying
3972 behavior. :safe means use only safe values, and ignore the rest.
3973 nil means ignore them all. Anything else means always query.
3974
3975 +++
3976 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3977 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3978 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3979 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3980 needed.
3981
3982 ---
3983 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3984 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3985 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3986 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3987 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3988 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3989
3990 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3991 confirmation as before.
3992
3993 ** Searching and matching changes:
3994
3995 +++
3996 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3997 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3998 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3999
4000 +++
4001 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
4002 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
4003 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
4004 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
4005
4006 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
4007 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
4008
4009 +++
4010 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
4011
4012 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
4013 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
4014 specified by the syntax table.
4015
4016 ---
4017 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
4018
4019 +++
4020 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
4021 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
4022 characters and ranges.
4023
4024 ---
4025 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4026 properties from surrounding text.
4027
4028 +++
4029 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4030 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4031 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4032
4033 +++
4034 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
4035 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
4036 passed to these functions will be reseated to point to nowhere.
4037
4038 +++
4039 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
4040 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
4041 that end a sentence without following spaces.
4042
4043 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
4044 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
4045 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
4046 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
4047 `sentence-end-without-space'.
4048
4049 ** Undo changes:
4050
4051 +++
4052 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
4053
4054 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
4055 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
4056 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
4057
4058 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
4059 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
4060 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
4061
4062 +++
4063 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
4064 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
4065 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
4066
4067 +++
4068 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
4069 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
4070
4071 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
4072 elements with the following format:
4073 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
4074
4075 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
4076 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
4077 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
4078 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
4079
4080 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
4081 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
4082 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4083 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4084 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4085 rectangle.
4086 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4087 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4088 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4089 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4090 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4091 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4092 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4093 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4094
4095 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4096 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4097 the killed text.
4098
4099 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4100 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4101 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4102 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4103 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4104
4105 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4106 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4107 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4108 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4109
4110 ** Syntax table changes:
4111
4112 +++
4113 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4114
4115 +++
4116 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4117 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4118 of text properties as well as the character code.
4119
4120 +++
4121 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4122 by `syntax-after').
4123
4124 +++
4125 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' provides an efficient way to find the
4126 current syntactic context at point.
4127
4128 ** File operation changes:
4129
4130 +++
4131 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4132 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4133
4134 +++
4135 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4136 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4137 operation.
4138
4139 +++
4140 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4141 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4142 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4143 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4144
4145 +++
4146 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4147 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4148
4149 +++
4150 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4151 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4152 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4153
4154 +++
4155 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4156
4157 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4158
4159 +++
4160 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4161 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4162
4163 +++
4164 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4165 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4166 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4167 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4168
4169 +++
4170 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4171 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4172 tasks. For example, it can be used by the copyright package to make
4173 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4174
4175 +++
4176 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4177 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4178 it's modified).
4179
4180 +++
4181 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4182 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4183 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4184 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4185 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4186 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4187 further filter candidate files.
4188
4189 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4190 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4191 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependencies.
4192
4193 ---
4194 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4195
4196 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4197 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4198 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4199 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4200 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4201
4202 +++
4203 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4204
4205 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4206 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4207 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4208 operations.
4209
4210 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4211 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4212
4213 +++
4214 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4215 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4216
4217 ** Input changes:
4218
4219 +++
4220 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4221 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4222 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4223
4224 +++
4225 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4226 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4227 it returns just the directory name.
4228
4229 ---
4230 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4231 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4232 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4233
4234 +++
4235 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4236 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4237 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4238 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4239 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4240
4241 ** Minibuffer changes:
4242
4243 +++
4244 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4245 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4246 defaults to the current buffer.
4247
4248 +++
4249 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4250 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4251
4252 +++
4253 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4254 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4255
4256 +++
4257 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4258 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The
4259 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4260 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4261 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4262
4263 ---
4264 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4265 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4266
4267 +++
4268 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4269 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4270 `read-file-name' function.
4271
4272 +++
4273 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4274
4275 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4276 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4277
4278 ** Completion changes:
4279
4280 +++
4281 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4282 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4283 operate on.
4284
4285 +++
4286 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4287 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4288 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4289 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4290 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4291
4292 +++
4293 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4294 as a dynamic completion table.
4295
4296 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4297
4298 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4299 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4300 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4301 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4302 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4303 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4304
4305 +++
4306 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4307 as a lazy completion table.
4308
4309 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4310
4311 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4312 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4313 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4314 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4315 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4316 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4317
4318 +++
4319 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4320
4321 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4322
4323 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4324 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4325 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4326 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4327 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4328 the spaces).
4329
4330 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4331
4332 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4333 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4334 example,
4335
4336 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4337
4338 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4339
4340 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4341 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4342 binding and lookup functionality.
4343
4344 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4345 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4346 original command.
4347
4348 Example:
4349 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4350 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4351 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4352 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4353 `kill-word'.
4354
4355 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4356 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4357 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4358
4359 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4360 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4361
4362 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4363 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4364
4365 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4366 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4367 runs `my-kill-line'.
4368
4369 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4370
4371 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4372 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4373 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4374 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4375
4376 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4377 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4378
4379 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4380 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4381
4382 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4383 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4384 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4385 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4386 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4387 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4388
4389 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4390 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4391 command was not remapped.
4392
4393 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4394 over minor mode keymaps.
4395
4396 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4397 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4398 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4399
4400 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4401
4402 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4403 bindings of the parent keymap.
4404
4405 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4406
4407 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4408 active keymaps.
4409
4410 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4411 defined keys and their definitions.
4412
4413 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4414
4415 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4416 in the keymap.
4417
4418 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4419
4420 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4421 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4422 keymap alist to this list.
4423
4424 ** Abbrev changes:
4425
4426 +++
4427 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4428
4429 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4430
4431 +++
4432 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4433
4434 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4435 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4436 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4437 specify this flag.
4438
4439 +++
4440 ** Enhancements to process support
4441
4442 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4443 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4444
4445 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4446
4447 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4448 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4449 functions.
4450
4451 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4452 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4453
4454 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4455 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4456
4457 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4458 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4459 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4460 entire property list of a process.
4461
4462 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4463 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4464 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4465 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4466 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4467 speech synthesis.
4468
4469 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4470
4471 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4472 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4473 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4474 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4475 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4476 from such processes, allowing them to produce more output before
4477 emacs tries to read it.
4478
4479 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4480
4481 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4482
4483 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4484 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4485 `default-directory'.
4486
4487 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4488 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4489
4490 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4491 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4492 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4493
4494 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4495 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4496
4497 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4498 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4499
4500 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4501 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4502 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4503 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4504 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4505
4506 +++
4507 ** Enhanced networking support.
4508
4509 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4510 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4511 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4512
4513 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4514 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4515 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4516 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4517 - IPv6 is supported (when available). You may explicitly select IPv6
4518 using :family 'ipv6 arg.
4519 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4520 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4521 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4522 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4523
4524 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4525 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4526 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:family ipv6))
4527
4528 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4529
4530 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4531
4532 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4533 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4534
4535 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4536
4537 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4538 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4539 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4540 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4541 string for other formatting options.
4542
4543 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4544
4545 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4546 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4547 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4548
4549 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4550 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4551
4552 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4553
4554 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4555 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4556 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4557 stopped state.
4558
4559 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4560
4561 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4562 current network addresses.
4563
4564 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4565
4566 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4567 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4568
4569 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4570
4571 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4572 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4573 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4574 "connection broken by remote peer".
4575
4576 ** Using window objects:
4577
4578 +++
4579 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4580
4581 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4582 header line.
4583
4584 +++
4585 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4586
4587 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4588 or the header line.
4589
4590 +++
4591 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4592
4593 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4594 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4595 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4596 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4597 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4598
4599 +++
4600 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4601 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4602 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4603 the mode line.
4604
4605 +++
4606 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4607 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4608
4609 +++
4610 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4611 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4612 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4613
4614 +++
4615 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4616
4617 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4618
4619 +++
4620 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4621 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4622 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4623 buffer.
4624
4625 +++
4626 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4627
4628 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4629 and scroll-bar settings.
4630
4631 +++
4632 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4636 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4637 dedicated windows.
4638
4639 +++
4640 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4641 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4642
4643 +++
4644 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4645
4646 *** New buffer-local variables `fringe-indicator-alist' and
4647 `fringe-cursor-alist' maps between logical (internal) fringe indicator
4648 and cursor symbols and the actual fringe bitmaps to be displayed.
4649 This decouples the logical meaning of the fringe indicators from the
4650 physical appearance, as well as allowing different fringe bitmaps to
4651 be used in different windows showing different buffers.
4652
4653 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4654 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4655
4656 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4657 identifying the bitmap such as `left-truncation' or `continued-line'.
4658
4659 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4660 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4661
4662 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4663 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4664 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4665 foreground color of the bitmap.
4666
4667 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4668 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4669 bitmap of the display line.
4670
4671 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4672 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4673 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4674 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4675 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4676
4677 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4678 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4679
4680 ** Other window fringe features:
4681
4682 +++
4683 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4684
4685 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4686 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4687 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4688 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4689
4690 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4691 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4692 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4693 between the left and right fringe. To force a specific fringe width,
4694 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4695 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4696
4697 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4698 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4699 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4700 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4701
4702 +++
4703 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4704
4705 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4706 position settings.
4707
4708 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4709 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4710 `set-window-fringes'.
4711
4712 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4713 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4714 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4715 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4716
4717 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4718 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4719 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4720 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4721 an update of the display margins.
4722
4723 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4724 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4725
4726 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4727 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4728 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4729 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4730 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4731 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4732 of the display margins.
4733
4734 ** Redisplay features:
4735
4736 +++
4737 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4738
4739 +++
4740 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4741 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4742 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4743 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4744 forcing an explicit window update.
4745
4746 +++
4747 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4748 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4749 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4750
4751 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4752 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4753
4754 +++
4755 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4756 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4757
4758 It contains a list of variables which contain overlay arrow position
4759 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4760
4761 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4762 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4763 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4764 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4765 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4766 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4767
4768 +++
4769 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4770
4771 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4772 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4773
4774 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4775 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4776 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4777 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4778 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4779
4780 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4781 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4782 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4783
4784 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4785 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4786 the given value.
4787
4788 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4789 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4790 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4791
4792 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4793 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4794
4795 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4796 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4797 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4798 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4799 exactly that many pixels high.
4800
4801 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4802 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4803 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4804 the `line-spacing' variable.
4805
4806 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4807 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4808
4809 +++
4810 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4811 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4812
4813 +++
4814 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4815
4816 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4817 PROPS is a property list, now allows pixel based width and height
4818 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4819
4820 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4821 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4822 are supported:
4823
4824 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4825 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4826 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4827 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4828 | scroll-bar | text
4829 POS ::= left | center | right
4830 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4831 OP ::= + | -
4832
4833 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4834 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4835 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4836 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4837 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4838 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4839 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4840 the image.
4841
4842 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4843 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4844 corresponding area of the window.
4845
4846 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4847 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4848 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4849 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4850 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4851 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4852 these symbols), further occurrences of these symbols are interpreted as
4853 the width of the area.
4854
4855 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4856 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4857
4858 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4859 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4860 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4861
4862 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4863 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4864 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4865 height) of the specified image.
4866
4867 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4868 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4869
4870 +++
4871 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4872 text property string that may be present at the current window
4873 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4874 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4875
4876 +++
4877 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4878 supported on text terminals.
4879
4880 +++
4881 *** Support for displaying image slices
4882
4883 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4884 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4885
4886 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4887 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4888
4889 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4890 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4891
4892 +++
4893 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4894
4895 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4896 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4897 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4898 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4899 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4900 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4901 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4902 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4903
4904 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4905 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4906 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4907 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4908 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4909 for possible pointer shapes.
4910
4911 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4912 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4913 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4914
4915 +++
4916 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4917 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4918 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4919 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4920 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4921 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4922 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4923
4924 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4925
4926 Note that all images formerly located in the lisp directory have been
4927 moved to etc/images.
4928
4929 +++
4930 *** New function `image-load-path-for-library' returns a suitable
4931 search path for images relative to library. This function is useful in
4932 external packages to save users from having to update
4933 `image-load-path'.
4934
4935 +++
4936 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4937 images that Emacs will load and display.
4938
4939 ** Mouse pointer features:
4940
4941 +++ (lispref)
4942 ??? (man)
4943 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4944 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4945 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4946 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4947 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4948
4949 +++
4950 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4951 :pointer image property.
4952
4953 +++
4954 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4955 controlled/overridden via the `pointer' text property.
4956
4957 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4958
4959 +++
4960 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4961 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4962
4963 +++
4964 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4965 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4966 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4967
4968 +++
4969 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4970
4971 +++
4972 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4973
4974 +++
4975 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4976 text area).
4977
4978 +++
4979 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4980 and all areas.
4981
4982 +++
4983 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4984 of the mouse event position.
4985
4986 +++
4987 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4988
4989 +++
4990 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4991 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4992
4993 +++
4994 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4995 (image or character) clicked on.
4996
4997 +++
4998 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4999
5000 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
5001 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
5002 the total width and height of that object.
5003
5004 ** Text property and overlay changes:
5005
5006 +++
5007 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
5008 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
5009
5010 +++
5011 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5012
5013 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
5014 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
5015 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
5016 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
5017
5018 +++
5019 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
5020 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
5021 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
5022 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
5023 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
5024
5025 +++
5026 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
5027
5028 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
5029 property names as argument rather than a property list.
5030
5031 ** Face changes
5032
5033 +++
5034 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
5035 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
5036 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
5037 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
5038 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
5039 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
5040
5041 +++
5042 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
5043 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
5044
5045 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
5046 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
5047 defined with `defface'.
5048
5049 ---
5050 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
5051 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
5052 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
5053 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
5054 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
5055
5056 +++
5057 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
5058 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
5059 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
5060 by them).
5061
5062 +++
5063 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
5064 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
5065 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
5066 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
5067 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
5068
5069 ---
5070 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
5071 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
5072 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
5073
5074 +++
5075 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
5076
5077 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
5078 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
5079 attribute.
5080
5081 +++
5082 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
5083 help with handling relative face attributes.
5084
5085 +++
5086 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
5087
5088 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
5089 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
5090 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
5091 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
5092 `face' properties.
5093
5094 ---
5095 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
5096 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
5097 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
5098 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
5099 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
5100
5101 ---
5102 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
5103 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
5104
5105 ** Font-Lock changes:
5106
5107 +++
5108 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
5109
5110 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5111 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5112 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5113 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5114
5115 +++
5116 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5117
5118 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5119 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5120 properties than `face'.
5121
5122 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5123 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5124
5125 ---
5126 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5127
5128 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5129 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5130 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5131 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5132 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5133
5134 s{
5135 foo
5136 }{
5137 bar
5138 }e
5139
5140 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5141 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5142 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5143 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5144
5145 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5146
5147 +++
5148 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5149 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5150 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5151 variable `magic-mode-alist'.
5152
5153 +++
5154 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5155
5156 +++
5157 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5158 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5159 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5160
5161 ---
5162 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5163 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5164 it in that buffer.
5165
5166 +++
5167 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5168 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5169 the language.
5170
5171 +++
5172 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5173 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5174
5175 +++
5176 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5177 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5178 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5179
5180 ** Minor mode changes:
5181
5182 +++
5183 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5184 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5185
5186 +++
5187 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5188
5189 +++
5190 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5191
5192 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5193 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5194
5195 ** Command loop changes:
5196
5197 +++
5198 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5199 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5200 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5201
5202 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5203 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5204
5205 +++
5206 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5207
5208 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5209 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5210 macros.
5211
5212 +++
5213 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5214 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5215 covered by an image or composition property.
5216
5217 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5218 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5219 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5220 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5221 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5222
5223 +++
5224 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5225 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5226 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5227 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5228 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5229
5230 +++
5231 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5232 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5233 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5234
5235 +++
5236 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5237 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5238
5239 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5240
5241 +++
5242 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5243 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5244 current file redefined it).
5245
5246 +++
5247 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5248 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5249
5250 +++
5251 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5252 variable or face definitions.
5253
5254 +++
5255 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5256 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5257 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5258
5259 ---
5260 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5261 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5262 than 3 levels of nesting.
5263
5264 +++
5265 ** Byte compiler changes:
5266
5267 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5268 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5269 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5270 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5271 compilation output buffer.
5272
5273 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5274 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5275
5276 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5277 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5278 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5279 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5280 forms:
5281
5282 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5283 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5284
5285 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5286 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5287 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5288 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5289 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5290 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5291
5292 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5293 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5294 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5295 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5296 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5297 you anything.
5298
5299 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5300
5301 ---
5302 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5303 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5304 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5305
5306 ** Frame operations:
5307
5308 +++
5309 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5310
5311 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5312 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5313
5314 +++
5315 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5316 for all (existing and future) frames.
5317
5318 +++
5319 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5320 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5321 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5322 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5323
5324 +++
5325 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5326 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5327
5328 ** Mule changes:
5329
5330 +++
5331 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5332
5333 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5334 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5335 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5336 now:
5337
5338 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5339
5340 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5341 the time it takes to convert the format.
5342
5343 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5344 wasteful.
5345
5346 ---
5347 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5348 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5349
5350 +++
5351 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5352 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5353 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5354 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5355
5356 ---
5357 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5358 of one coding system from another coding system.
5359
5360 ---
5361 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5362 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5363 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5364
5365 +++
5366 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5367 it is read from a file without decoding.
5368
5369 ---
5370 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5371 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5372
5373 ---
5374 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5375 current input method to input a character.
5376
5377 ** Mode line changes:
5378
5379 +++
5380 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5381
5382 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5383 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5384
5385 +++
5386 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5387 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5388
5389 +++
5390 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5391 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5392 line.
5393
5394 +++
5395 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5396
5397 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5398
5399 ---
5400 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5401 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5402 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5403 several versions ago.
5404
5405 ---
5406 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5407 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5408 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5409
5410 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5411 made with easy-menu.
5412
5413 ---
5414 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5415 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5416 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5417 need to have a name.
5418
5419 ** Operating system access:
5420
5421 +++
5422 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5423 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5424
5425 +++
5426 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5427 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5428 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5429
5430 +++
5431 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5432
5433 ---
5434 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5435 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5436 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5437
5438 ---
5439 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5440 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5441
5442 ** Miscellaneous:
5443
5444 +++
5445 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5446
5447 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5448 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5449 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5450 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5451 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5452 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5453 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5454
5455 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5456
5457 +++
5458 *** Variable `local-write-file-hooks' is marked obsolete.
5459
5460 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5461
5462 ---
5463 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5464 running under X.
5465
5466 ** GC changes:
5467
5468 +++
5469 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5470 as the heap size increases.
5471
5472 +++
5473 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5474 on garbage collection.
5475
5476 +++
5477 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5478
5479 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5480 \f
5481 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5482
5483 +++
5484 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5485 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5486 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5487 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5488 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5489
5490 ---
5491 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5492 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5493 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5494
5495 +++
5496 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5497 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5498 data structures.
5499
5500 ---
5501 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5502 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5503
5504 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5505 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5506 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5507 commands.
5508
5509 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5510 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5511 SQL buffer.
5512
5513 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5514 (function (lambda ()
5515 (master-mode t)
5516 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5517 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5518 (function (lambda ()
5519 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5520
5521 +++
5522 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5523
5524 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5525
5526 +++
5527 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5528
5529 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5530 code. It works with edebug.
5531
5532 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5533 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5534 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5535 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5536 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5537
5538 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5539 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5540 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5541 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5542 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5543 value, such as (setq x 14).
5544
5545 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5546 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5547 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5548 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5549 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5550 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5551 \f
5552 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5553
5554 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5555 been added.
5556
5557 \f
5558 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5559
5560 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5561 with Custom.
5562
5563 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5564 as mule-utf-8.
5565
5566 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5567 in UTF-8 locales).
5568
5569 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5570 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5571 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5572 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5573 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5574 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5575 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5576 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5577 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5578 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5579
5580 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5581 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5582
5583 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5584 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5585 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5586 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5587 contrary to the compound text specification.
5588
5589 \f
5590 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5591
5592 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5593
5594 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5595
5596 \f
5597 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5598
5599 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5600
5601 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5602 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5603 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5604 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5605 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5606
5607 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5608 were changed.
5609
5610 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5611 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5612
5613 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5614 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5615 instead of using default-major-mode.
5616
5617 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5618 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5619 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5620 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5621 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5622 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5623 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5624
5625 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5626 NEWS.
5627
5628 \f
5629 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5630
5631 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5632 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5633 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5634
5635 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5636 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5637
5638 \f
5639 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5640
5641 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5642 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5643 charsets in this release.
5644
5645 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5646
5647 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5648
5649 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5650 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5651 to list them.
5652
5653 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5654 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5655 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5656 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5657 necessary changes to unexec.
5658
5659 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5660 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5661
5662 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5663 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5664
5665 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5666 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5667
5668 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5669 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5670 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5671 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5672 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5673
5674 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5675 new display features described below.
5676
5677 \f
5678 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5679
5680 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5681
5682 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5683 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5684 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5685 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5686 the text.
5687
5688 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5689
5690 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5691 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5692 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5693 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5694 specify a font.
5695
5696 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5697 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5698 under Lisp changes, below.
5699
5700 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5701
5702 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5703 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5704 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5705 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5706 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5707 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5708 on terminals.
5709
5710 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5711 supported on character terminals.
5712
5713 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5714 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5715 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5716 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5717
5718 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5719
5720 ** Sound support
5721
5722 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5723 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5724 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5725 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5726 sound support.
5727
5728 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5729
5730 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5731 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5732 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5733 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5734
5735 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5736
5737 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5738 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5739 specifies a number of lines.
5740
5741 Default is 0.25.
5742
5743 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5744
5745 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5746 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5747 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5748 again.
5749
5750 Default is `grow-only'.
5751
5752 ** LessTif support.
5753
5754 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5755 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5756
5757 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5758
5759 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5760 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5761 non-nil.
5762
5763 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5764
5765 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5766 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5767 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5768
5769 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5770
5771 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5772 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5773 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5774 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5775 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5776 Emacs.
5777
5778 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5779 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5780 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5781 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5782 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5783 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5784
5785 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5786 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5787 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5788 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5789 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5790 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5791
5792 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5793 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5794 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5795 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5796 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5797
5798 ** Tool bar support.
5799
5800 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5801 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5802 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5803 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5804 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5805 icons will be used.
5806
5807 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5808 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5809
5810 ** Tooltips.
5811
5812 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5813 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5814 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5815
5816 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5817 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5818 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5819 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5820
5821 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5822
5823 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5824 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5825 customized.
5826
5827 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5828 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5829 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5830 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5831 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5832
5833 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5834 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5835 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5836 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5837 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5838 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5839
5840 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5841 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5842 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5843 customizing face `fringe'.
5844
5845 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5846 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5847 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5848 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5849 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5850 the window to be partially obscured.)
5851
5852 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5853 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5854 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5855 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5856
5857 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5858
5859 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5860 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5861 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5862 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5863 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5864 have enabled one.
5865
5866 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5867
5868 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5869
5870 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5871
5872 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5873 `*') toggles the status.
5874
5875 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5876
5877 ** Hourglass pointer
5878
5879 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5880 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5881
5882 ** Blinking cursor
5883
5884 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5885 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5886 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5887 the group `cursor'.
5888
5889 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5890
5891 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5892 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5893 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5894 details.
5895
5896 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5897 have to do anything to activate it.
5898
5899 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5900
5901 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5902 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5903
5904 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5905 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5906 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5907 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5908 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5909 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5910 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5911 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5912
5913 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5914 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5915 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5916 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5917 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5918 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5919
5920 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5921 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5922
5923 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5924 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5925 buffer by default.
5926
5927 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5928 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5929 beginning and end of the buffer.
5930
5931 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5932 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5933 signaled.
5934
5935 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5936 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5937
5938 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5939 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5940 this behavior.
5941
5942 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5943 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5944 Emacs dump core.
5945
5946 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5947
5948 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5949 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5950 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5951
5952 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5953 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5954 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5955
5956 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5957 using that menu.
5958
5959 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5960
5961 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5962 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5963 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5964 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5965 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5966 whitespace.
5967
5968 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5969 all frames except the selected one.
5970
5971 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5972 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5973
5974 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5975 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5976 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5977 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5978 `Info-use-header-line'.
5979
5980 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5981 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5982 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5983
5984 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5985
5986 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5987 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5988 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5989
5990 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5991 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5992 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5993 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5994
5995 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5996
5997 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5998 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5999 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
6000 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
6001
6002 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
6003 point in a pop-up window.
6004
6005 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
6006 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
6007 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
6008
6009 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
6010 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
6011
6012 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
6013 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
6014 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
6015 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
6016
6017 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
6018
6019 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6020 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6021
6022 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
6023 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
6024 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
6025
6026 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
6027 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
6028 non-nil.
6029
6030 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
6031 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
6032 file that is already visited under a different name.
6033
6034 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
6035 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
6036
6037 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
6038 and displays information about that.
6039
6040 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
6041 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
6042
6043 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
6044 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
6045 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
6046 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
6047 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
6048 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
6049
6050 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
6051 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
6052
6053 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
6054 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
6055 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
6056 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
6057 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
6058 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
6059 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
6060
6061 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
6062 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
6063
6064 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
6065 system for keyboard input.
6066
6067 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
6068 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
6069 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
6070 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
6071 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
6072 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
6073 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
6074 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
6075 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
6076
6077 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
6078 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
6079
6080 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
6081 displays all characters in that character set.
6082
6083 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
6084 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
6085
6086 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
6087 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
6088 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
6089
6090 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
6091 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
6092 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
6093 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
6094 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
6095 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6096 and Polish `slash'.
6097
6098 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6099 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6100 of the tutorial.
6101
6102 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6103 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6104 Lisp Coding Convention".
6105
6106 new command old-binding
6107 --- ------- -----------
6108 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6109 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6110 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6111
6112 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6113 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6114 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6115
6116 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6117 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6118 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6119 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6120 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6121 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6122
6123 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6124 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6125 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6126 package.
6127
6128 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6129 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6130 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6131 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6132 "`", you must type "=q".
6133
6134 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6135 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6136 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6137 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6138 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6139 on.
6140
6141 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6142 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6143 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6144 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6145
6146 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6147 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6148 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6149 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6150
6151 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6152 on the display using several methods
6153
6154 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6155 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6156 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6157
6158 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6159 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6160
6161 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6162
6163 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6164 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6165
6166 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6167 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6168 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6169 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6170
6171 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6172 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6173 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6174
6175 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6176 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6177
6178 ** New X resources recognized
6179
6180 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6181 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6182 is useful for debugging X problems.
6183
6184 Example:
6185
6186 emacs.synchronous: true
6187
6188 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6189 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6190 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6191 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6192 visual class names are
6193
6194 TrueColor
6195 PseudoColor
6196 DirectColor
6197 StaticColor
6198 GrayScale
6199 StaticGray
6200
6201 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6202 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6203 meaning.
6204
6205 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6206 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6207 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6208 visual.
6209
6210 Example:
6211
6212 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6213
6214 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6215 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6216 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6217 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6218
6219 Example:
6220
6221 emacs.privateColormap: true
6222
6223 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6224
6225 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6226 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6227 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6228 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6229 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6230 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6231 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6232
6233 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6234 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6235 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6236 `default' face and vice versa.
6237
6238 ** New face `menu'.
6239
6240 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6241
6242 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6243
6244 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6245 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6246 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6247 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6248
6249 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6250 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6251 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6252
6253 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6254 `ScreenGamma'.
6255
6256 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6257
6258 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6259 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6260 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6261 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6262
6263 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6264
6265 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6266
6267 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6268
6269 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6270 LessTif/Motif one.
6271
6272 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6273 LessTif and Motif.
6274
6275 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6276
6277 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6278 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6279 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6280
6281 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6282 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6283
6284 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6285 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6286 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6287
6288 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6289
6290 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6291 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6292 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6293 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6294
6295 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6296 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6297 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6298 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6299
6300 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6301 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6302 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6303 buffers.
6304
6305 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6306
6307 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6308 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6309 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6310
6311 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6312 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6313 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6314 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6315 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6316 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6317
6318 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6319
6320 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6321 notably at the end of lines.
6322
6323 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6324 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6325
6326 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6327
6328 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6329 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6330
6331 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6332 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6333 after each match to get the replacement text.
6334
6335 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6336 you edit the replacement string.
6337
6338 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6339 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6340 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6341
6342 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6343
6344 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6345 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6346
6347 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6348 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6349 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6350 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6351
6352 --
6353 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6354 read mail from the menu etc.
6355
6356 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6357 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6358 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6359 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6360
6361 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6362 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6363
6364 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6365 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6366 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6367 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6368 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6369 of Emacs.
6370
6371 ** Customize changes
6372
6373 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6374 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6375 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6376 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6377 earlier versions of Emacs.
6378
6379 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6380 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6381 default).
6382
6383 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6384 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6385 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6386 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6387 file.
6388
6389 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6390 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6391 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6392 already in your init file.
6393
6394 ** New features in evaluation commands
6395
6396 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6397 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6398 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6399 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6400 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6401
6402 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6403 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6404 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6405 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6406 printed).
6407
6408 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6409 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6410
6411 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6412 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6413
6414 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6415 code when called with a prefix argument.
6416
6417 ** CC mode changes.
6418
6419 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6420 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6421 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6422 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6423 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6424 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6425 release.
6426
6427 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6428 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6429 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6430 confusion.
6431
6432 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6433 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6434 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6435 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6436
6437 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6438 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6439
6440 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6441 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6442
6443 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6444 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6445 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6446 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6447
6448 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6449 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6450 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6451 earlier statement. An example:
6452
6453 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6454 if (a[i])
6455 res += a[i]->offset;
6456 else
6457
6458 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6459 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6460 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6461 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6462 the preceding "if".
6463
6464 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6465 by default.
6466
6467 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6468 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6469 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6470 documentation or other natural language text.
6471
6472 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6473 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6474 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6475 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6476 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6477 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6478 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6479
6480 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6481 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6482 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6483 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6484
6485 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6486 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6487 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6488 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6489 Pike mode only.
6490
6491 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6492 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6493 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6494 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6495 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6496 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6497 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6498 is reported afterwards.
6499
6500 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6501 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6502 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6503
6504 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6505 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6506 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6507 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6508 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6509 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6510 groundwork.
6511
6512 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6513 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6514 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6515 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6516 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6517 have to bother.
6518
6519 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6520 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6521 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6522 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6523 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6524 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6525
6526 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6527 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6528 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6529 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6530 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6531 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6532 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6533 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6534
6535 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6536 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6537 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6538 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6539 above.
6540
6541 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6542 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6543 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6544 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6545 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6546 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6547 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6548 function documentation for more info.
6549
6550 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6551 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6552 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6553 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6554 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6555 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6556 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6557 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6558
6559 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6560
6561 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6562 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6563
6564 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6565 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6566 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6567 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6568 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6569 style system.
6570
6571 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6572 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6573 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6574 as far as possible.
6575
6576 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6577 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6578 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6579 chapter about this in the manual.
6580
6581 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6582 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6583 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6584 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6585 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6586
6587 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6588 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6589 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6590
6591 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6592 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6593
6594 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6595 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6596 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6597 inside CC Mode.
6598
6599 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6600 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6601 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6602 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6603 cc-mode/).
6604
6605 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6606 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6607 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6608 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6609 they were before the filling.
6610
6611 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6612 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6613 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6614 literals.
6615
6616 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6617 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6618 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6619 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6620 this function.
6621
6622 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6623 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6624 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6625 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6626 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6627
6628 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6629 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6630 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6631
6632 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6633
6634 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6635 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6636 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6637 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6638
6639 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6640 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6641 the column specified by comment-column.
6642
6643 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6644 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6645 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6646 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6647 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6648 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6649
6650 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6651 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6652 arguments.
6653
6654 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6655
6656 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6657 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6658 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6659 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6660 Provan).
6661
6662 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6663
6664 ** Dired changes
6665
6666 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6667 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6668 is, delete only empty directories.
6669
6670 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6671 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6672 copy directories recursively.
6673
6674 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6675 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6676 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6677
6678 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6679 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6680 directory.
6681
6682 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6683 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6684 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6685 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6686 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6687
6688 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6689 from ls switches.
6690
6691 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6692 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6693 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6694 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6695
6696 ** Gnus changes.
6697
6698 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6699 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6700 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6701
6702 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6703 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6704
6705 If you used procmail like in
6706
6707 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6708 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6709 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6710 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6711
6712 this now has changed to
6713
6714 (setq mail-sources
6715 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6716 :suffix ".in")))
6717
6718 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6719 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6720
6721 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6722 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6723 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6724 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6725
6726 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6727 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6728 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6729
6730 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6731 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6732 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6733 now just a compatibility layer.
6734
6735 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6736 Gnus facilities.
6737
6738 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6739 called to position point.
6740
6741 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6742 summary buffers and NOV files.
6743
6744 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6745 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6746
6747 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6748 subtly different manner.
6749
6750 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6751 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6752 ever-changing layouts.
6753
6754 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6755
6756 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6757
6758 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6759
6760 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6761 macros
6762
6763 Key binding Macro
6764 -------------------------
6765 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6766 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6767 C-c C-c u @uref
6768 C-c C-c q @quotation
6769 C-c C-c m @email
6770 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6771 M-RET @item
6772
6773 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6774
6775 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6776
6777 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6778 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6779 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6780
6781 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6782
6783 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6784 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6785 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6786 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6787 buffers to kill, as before.
6788
6789 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6790 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6791 this way.
6792
6793 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6794 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6795
6796 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6797
6798 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6799 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6800 use. Default is 1000.
6801
6802 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6803 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6804
6805 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6806
6807 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6808
6809 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6810 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6811 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6812 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6813
6814 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6815 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6816 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6817 the open block.
6818
6819 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6820 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6821 the normal block-hiding function.
6822
6823 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6824
6825 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6826 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6827 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6828 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6829
6830 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6831 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6832
6833 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6834
6835 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6836 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6837 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6838
6839 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6840 current buffer.
6841
6842 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6843 in a log file.
6844
6845 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6846 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6847 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6848 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6849 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6850 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6851
6852 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6853
6854 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6855
6856 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6857 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6858
6859 ** Changes in Font Lock
6860
6861 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6862 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6863
6864 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6865 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6866
6867 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6868 the face used for each string/comment.
6869
6870 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6871 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6872
6873 ** Changes to Shell mode
6874
6875 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6876 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6877 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6878 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6879
6880 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6881
6882 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6883 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6884
6885 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6886 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6887 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6888 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6889 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6890 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6891
6892 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6893 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6894 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6895 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6896 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6897 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6898 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6899 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6900
6901 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6902 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6903
6904 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6905 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6906 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6907
6908 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6909 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6910 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6911
6912 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6913 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6914 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6915
6916 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6917 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6918 argument, it appends to the file.
6919
6920 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6921 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6922 compatibility.
6923
6924 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6925 ring (history).
6926
6927 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6928 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6929 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6930
6931 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6932
6933 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6934 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6935 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6936 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6937 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6938 as correspondent.
6939
6940 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6941 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6942 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6943
6944 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6945 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6946 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6947 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6948 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6949
6950 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6951 like `j'.
6952
6953 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6954 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6955 digest message.
6956
6957 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6958 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6959
6960 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6961 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6962 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6963
6964 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6965 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6966
6967 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6968 use the -f option when sending mail.
6969
6970 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6971 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6972 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6973 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6974 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6975 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6976
6977 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6978 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6979 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6980
6981 ** Changes to TeX mode
6982
6983 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6984 `latex-mode'.
6985
6986 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6987
6988 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6989
6990 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6991
6992 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6993
6994 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6995 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6996 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6997 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6998 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6999 can be edited from that buffer.
7000
7001 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
7002 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
7003 `A' to use all marked entries).
7004
7005 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
7006 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
7007
7008 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
7009 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
7010 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
7011 been cited.
7012
7013 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
7014 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
7015 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
7016 in column 1 are always made leaves.
7017
7018 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
7019 has the following new features:
7020
7021 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
7022 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
7023 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
7024 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
7025
7026 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
7027 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
7028 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
7029 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
7030 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
7031 defaults to 1.
7032
7033 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
7034 file names.
7035
7036 ** Ispell changes
7037
7038 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
7039 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
7040 spell-checks the current buffer.
7041
7042 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
7043 added.
7044
7045 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
7046 correction is made and re-checked.
7047
7048 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
7049
7050 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
7051 cases.
7052
7053 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
7054 on syntax errors.
7055
7056 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
7057 end of the buffer.
7058
7059 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
7060
7061 ** Makefile mode changes
7062
7063 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
7064
7065 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
7066 Fontlock mode is active.
7067
7068 ** Isearch changes
7069
7070 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
7071 so that searches can be resumed.
7072
7073 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
7074 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
7075 that started the search.
7076
7077 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
7078 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
7079
7080 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
7081
7082 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
7083 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
7084 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
7085 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
7086 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
7087 `secondary-selection'.
7088
7089 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
7090 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
7091 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
7092 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
7093 usual snappy response.
7094
7095 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7096 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7097 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7098 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7099
7100 ** VC Changes
7101
7102 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7103 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7104 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7105 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7106 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7107 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7108 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7109 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7110 file is registered in that backend.
7111
7112 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7113 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7114 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7115 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7116 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7117 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7118
7119 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7120 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7121 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7122 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7123 where it doesn't make sense.)
7124
7125 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7126 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7127 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7128
7129 *** General Changes
7130
7131 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7132 checks are always done now.
7133
7134 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7135 operations.
7136
7137 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7138 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7139 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7140
7141 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7142 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7143 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7144 the working file (``merge news'').
7145
7146 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7147 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7148 downwards.
7149
7150 *** Multiple Backends
7151
7152 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7153 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7154 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7155 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7156 local RCS archives.
7157
7158 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7159 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7160 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7161 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7162
7163 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7164 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7165 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7166 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7167 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7168
7169 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7170 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7171 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7172 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7173
7174 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7175 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7176 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7177 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7178
7179 *** Changes for CVS
7180
7181 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7182 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7183 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7184 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7185 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7186 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7187 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7188
7189 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7190 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7191 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7192 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7193 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7194 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7195 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7196 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7197 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7198 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7199 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7200 name.)
7201
7202 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7203 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7204 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7205 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7206 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7207 entire directory tree.
7208
7209 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7210 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7211 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7212 "watched" by other developers.)
7213
7214 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7215 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7216 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7217 starting at the given directory.
7218
7219 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7220
7221 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7222 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7223 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7224 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7225 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7226 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7227 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7228 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7229 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7230
7231 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7232 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7233 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7234 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7235
7236 ** New modes and packages
7237
7238 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7239 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7240 the default is not applicable.
7241
7242 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7243 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7244 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7245
7246 Features are:
7247
7248 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7249 drawn, like this: | \ /
7250 --+-- X
7251 | / \
7252
7253 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7254 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7255 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7256 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7257 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7258 you are drawing.
7259
7260 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7261 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7262
7263 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7264 flood-filling.
7265
7266 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7267 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7268 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7269 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7270
7271 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7272 also do without the mouse.
7273
7274 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7275 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7276 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7277 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7278 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7279
7280 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7281
7282 lines straight-lines
7283 rectangles squares
7284 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7285 ellipses circles
7286 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7287 spray-can setting size for spraying
7288 vaporize line vaporize lines
7289 erase characters erase rectangles
7290
7291 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7292 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7293 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7294 drawing.
7295
7296 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7297 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7298 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7299 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7300
7301 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7302 can be turned off).
7303
7304 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7305 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7306 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7307 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7308 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7309 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7310 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7311 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7312 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7313
7314 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7315 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7316 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7317 on certain projects.
7318
7319 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7320 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7321
7322 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7323
7324 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7325 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7326 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7327 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7328 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7329 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7330 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7331 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7332
7333 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7334 Emacs is idle.
7335
7336 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7337 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7338
7339 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7340 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7341
7342 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7343 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7344 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7345 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7346 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7347
7348 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7349 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7350 separate Texinfo file.
7351
7352 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7353 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7354 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7355 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7356 enter check-in log messages.
7357
7358 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7359 without invoking external programs.
7360
7361 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7362 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7363 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7364 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7365 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7366
7367 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7368 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7369
7370 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7371 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7372
7373 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7374 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7375 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7376 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7377 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7378 single step.
7379
7380 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7381 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7382 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7383 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7384
7385 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7386 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7387 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7388
7389 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7390 PostScript.
7391
7392 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7393
7394 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7395
7396 ; comment (until end of line)
7397 A non-terminal
7398 "C" terminal
7399 ?C? special
7400 $A default non-terminal
7401 $"C" default terminal
7402 $?C? default special
7403 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7404 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7405 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7406 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7407 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7408 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7409 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7410 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7411 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7412 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7413 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7414 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7415 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7416 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7417 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7418
7419 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7420
7421 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7422 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7423 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7424 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7425 equal signs of assignments.
7426
7427 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7428 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7429
7430 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7431 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7432 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7433
7434 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7435
7436 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7437 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7438 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7439 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7440 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7441 which answers different needs.
7442
7443 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7444 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7445 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7446 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7447 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7448 to be enabled.
7449
7450 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7451 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7452
7453 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7454
7455 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7456 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7457 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7458
7459 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7460
7461 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7462 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7463 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7464 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7465 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7466 and background colors.
7467
7468 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7469 Pascal) language.
7470
7471 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7472 the text at point.
7473
7474 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7475
7476 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7477
7478 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7479 whitespace in a file.
7480
7481 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7482 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7483 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7484 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7485 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7486 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7487 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7488
7489 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7490
7491 Here is an example of columns:
7492
7493 horse apple bus
7494 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7495 porcupine strawberry airplane
7496
7497 Doing the following settings:
7498
7499 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7500 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7501 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7502 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7503
7504
7505 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7506
7507 M-x delimit-columns-region
7508
7509 It results:
7510
7511 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7512 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7513 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7514
7515 delim-col has the following options:
7516
7517 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7518 before all columns.
7519
7520 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7521 between each column.
7522
7523 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7524 after all columns.
7525
7526 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7527 each column.
7528
7529 delim-col has the following commands:
7530
7531 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7532 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7533
7534 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7535 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7536 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7537 recent file list can be displayed:
7538
7539 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7540 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7541 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7542
7543 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7544 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7545
7546 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7547 text.
7548
7549 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7550 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7551 specific to Message mode.
7552
7553 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7554 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7555 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7556
7557 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7558 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7559 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7560
7561 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7562 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7563
7564 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7565
7566 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7567 minibuffer with completion.
7568
7569 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7570 with the diary features.
7571
7572 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7573 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7574
7575 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7576 Fill mode.
7577
7578 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7579 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7580 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7581 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7582
7583 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7584 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7585 `.g'.
7586
7587 ** Changes in sort.el
7588
7589 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7590 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7591 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7592 numeric base.
7593
7594 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7595
7596 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7597 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7598 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7599
7600 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7601 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7602
7603 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7604 output ^M at the end of lines.
7605
7606 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7607 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7608
7609 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7610 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7611 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7612
7613 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7614 group.
7615
7616 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7617 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7618 are recognized:
7619
7620 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7621 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7622 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7623 nil -- just delete one character.
7624
7625 Default value is `untabify'.
7626
7627 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7628
7629 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7630 symbol, not double-quoted.
7631
7632 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7633 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7634 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7635 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7636
7637 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7638 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7639 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7640
7641 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7642 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7643 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7644
7645 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7646 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7647
7648 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7649 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7650
7651 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7652 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7653
7654 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7655 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7656 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7657 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7658 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7659 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7660
7661 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7662 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7663
7664 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7665
7666 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7667 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7668
7669 ** Shell script mode changes.
7670
7671 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7672 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7673 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7674
7675 ** Etags changes.
7676
7677 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7678
7679 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7680 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7681 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7682 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7683 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7684
7685 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7686 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7687
7688 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7689 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7690
7691 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7692 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7693 `template' keywords.
7694
7695 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7696 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7697
7698 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7699 types.
7700
7701 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7702
7703 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7704
7705 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7706 are now tagged.
7707
7708 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7709
7710 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7711 variables are tagged.
7712
7713 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7714
7715 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7716 for PSWrap.
7717
7718 ** Changes in etags.el
7719
7720 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7721 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7722 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7723
7724 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7725 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7726
7727 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7728 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7729 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7730 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7731
7732 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7733
7734 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7735 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7736
7737 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7738
7739 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7740 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7741 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7742
7743 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7744 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7745
7746 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7747 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7748
7749 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7750 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7751 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7752 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7753 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7754
7755 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7756 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7757 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7758
7759 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7760 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7761 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7762
7763 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7764 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7765 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7766
7767 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7768
7769 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7770
7771 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7772 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7773 expression from that list, are not checked.
7774
7775 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7776 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7777 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7778 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7779
7780 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7781
7782 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7783 displays local abbrevs, only.
7784
7785 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7786 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7787
7788 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7789 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7790 is measured in pixels.
7791
7792 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7793 to be visited as images.
7794
7795 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7796 were added to compile.el.
7797
7798 ** Withdrawn packages
7799
7800 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7801 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7802
7803 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7804
7805 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7806
7807 \f
7808 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7809
7810 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7811 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7812 See the sections below for details.
7813
7814 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7815 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7816 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7817 to remove the properties of the copy.
7818
7819 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7820 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7821 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7822 these properties are active.
7823
7824 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7825 ranges may affect some code.
7826
7827 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7828 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7829 make a difference to some code.
7830
7831 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7832 operates on the minibuffer.
7833
7834 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7835 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7836 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7837 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7838 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7839 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7840 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7841 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7842 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7843 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7844 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7845 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7846
7847 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7848 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7849 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7850
7851 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7852 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7853 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7854
7855 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7856 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7857 such as `mapconcat'.
7858
7859 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7860 string.
7861
7862 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7863 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7864 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7865 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7866 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7867 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7868 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7869 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7870
7871 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7872 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7873 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7874 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7875 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7876 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7877 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7878 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7879 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7880 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7881
7882 \f
7883 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7884 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7885
7886 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7887
7888 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7889 allows the animated display of strings.
7890
7891 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7892 interactive form of a function.
7893
7894 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7895 between custom options. Example:
7896
7897 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7898 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7899 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7900 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7901 :group 'mule
7902 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7903 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7904
7905 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7906 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7907 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7908
7909 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7910 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7911 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7912 (signal or normal termination).
7913
7914 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7915 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7916
7917 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7918 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7919
7920 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7921 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7922
7923 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7924
7925 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7926 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7927 being deleted.
7928
7929 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7930
7931 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7932 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7933 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7934 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7935 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7936 charset.
7937
7938 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7939 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7940 message.
7941
7942 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7943 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7944
7945 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7946 with the more general `:mask' property.
7947
7948 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7949
7950 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7951 backslash.
7952
7953 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7954 is running in batch mode. For example,
7955
7956 (message "%s" (read t))
7957
7958 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7959 to standard output.
7960
7961 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7962 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7963
7964 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7965 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7966 frame or window.
7967
7968 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7969 were added
7970
7971 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7972
7973 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7974 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7975
7976 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7977
7978 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7979 comparison is done with `eq'.
7980
7981 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7982
7983 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7984 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7985 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7986
7987 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7988 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7989 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7990
7991 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7992 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7993
7994 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7995 function was declared obsolete.
7996
7997 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7998 retained as an alias).
7999
8000 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
8001 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
8002
8003 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
8004
8005 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
8006
8007 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
8008 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
8009 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
8010 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
8011 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
8012 means never include the minibuffer window.
8013
8014 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
8015
8016 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
8017
8018 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
8019
8020 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
8021 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
8022 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
8023 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
8024 returned.
8025
8026 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
8027 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
8028 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
8029 minibuffer even if it is active.
8030
8031 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
8032 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
8033 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
8034 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
8035 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
8036 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
8037
8038 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
8039 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
8040 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
8041 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
8042 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
8043 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
8044 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
8045
8046 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
8047 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
8048 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
8049
8050 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
8051 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
8052 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
8053 Default value is nil.
8054
8055 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
8056 meaning no limit.
8057
8058 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
8059 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
8060 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
8061
8062 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
8063 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
8064 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
8065
8066 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
8067 list of a primitive.
8068
8069 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
8070
8071 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
8072 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
8073 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
8074 than replacing the local map.
8075
8076 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
8077 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
8078 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
8079 instead.
8080
8081 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
8082
8083 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
8084 as promised long ago.
8085
8086 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
8087
8088 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
8089 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
8090 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
8091
8092 \f
8093 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
8094
8095 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8096 regular expressions.
8097
8098 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8099
8100 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8101
8102 - Macro: rx SEXP
8103
8104 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8105
8106 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8107 notation.
8108
8109 STRING
8110 matches string STRING literally.
8111
8112 CHAR
8113 matches character CHAR literally.
8114
8115 `not-newline'
8116 matches any character except a newline.
8117 .
8118 `anything'
8119 matches any character
8120
8121 `(any SET)'
8122 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8123 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8124
8125 '(in SET)'
8126 like `any'.
8127
8128 `(not (any SET))'
8129 matches any character not in SET
8130
8131 `line-start'
8132 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8133 in the text being matched
8134
8135 `line-end'
8136 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8137
8138 `string-start'
8139 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8140 string being matched against.
8141
8142 `string-end'
8143 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8144 string being matched against.
8145
8146 `buffer-start'
8147 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8148 buffer being matched against.
8149
8150 `buffer-end'
8151 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8152 buffer being matched against.
8153
8154 `point'
8155 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8156
8157 `word-start'
8158 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8159 word.
8160
8161 `word-end'
8162 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8163
8164 `word-boundary'
8165 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8166 word.
8167
8168 `(not word-boundary)'
8169 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8170 word.
8171
8172 `digit'
8173 matches 0 through 9.
8174
8175 `control'
8176 matches ASCII control characters.
8177
8178 `hex-digit'
8179 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8180
8181 `blank'
8182 matches space and tab only.
8183
8184 `graphic'
8185 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8186 space, and DEL.
8187
8188 `printing'
8189 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8190 and DEL.
8191
8192 `alphanumeric'
8193 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8194 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8195
8196 `letter'
8197 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8198 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8199
8200 `ascii'
8201 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8202
8203 `nonascii'
8204 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8205
8206 `lower'
8207 matches anything lower-case.
8208
8209 `upper'
8210 matches anything upper-case.
8211
8212 `punctuation'
8213 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8214 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8215
8216 `space'
8217 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8218
8219 `word'
8220 matches anything that has word syntax.
8221
8222 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8223 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8224 of the following symbols.
8225
8226 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8227 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8228 `word' (\\sw)
8229 `symbol' (\\s_)
8230 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8231 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8232 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8233 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8234 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8235 `escape' (\\s\\)
8236 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8237 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8238 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8239
8240 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8241 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8242
8243 `(category CATEGORY)'
8244 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8245 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8246
8247 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8248 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8249 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8250 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8251 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8252 `symbol' (\\c5)
8253 `digit' (\\c6)
8254 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8255 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8256 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8257 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8258 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8259 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8260 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8261 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8262 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8263 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8264 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8265 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8266 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8267 `ascii' (\\ca)
8268 `arabic' (\\cb)
8269 `chinese' (\\cc)
8270 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8271 `greek' (\\cg)
8272 `korean' (\\ch)
8273 `indian' (\\ci)
8274 `japanese' (\\cj)
8275 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8276 `latin' (\\cl)
8277 `lao' (\\co)
8278 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8279 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8280 `thai' (\\ct)
8281 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8282 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8283 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8284 `can-break' (\\c|)
8285
8286 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8287 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8288
8289 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8290 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8291
8292 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8293 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8294 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8295
8296 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8297 another name for `submatch'.
8298
8299 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8300 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8301 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8302 regular expression.
8303
8304 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8305 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8306 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8307 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8308 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8309
8310 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8311 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8312
8313 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8314 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8315
8316 `(0+ SEXP)'
8317 like `zero-or-more'.
8318
8319 `(* SEXP)'
8320 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8321
8322 `(*? SEXP)'
8323 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8324
8325 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8326 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8327
8328 `(1+ SEXP)'
8329 like `one-or-more'.
8330
8331 `(+ SEXP)'
8332 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8333
8334 `(+? SEXP)'
8335 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8336
8337 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8338 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8339
8340 `(optional SEXP)'
8341 like `zero-or-one'.
8342
8343 `(? SEXP)'
8344 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8345
8346 `(?? SEXP)'
8347 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8348
8349 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8350 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8351
8352 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8353 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8354
8355 `(eval FORM)'
8356 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8357 `regexp-quote' it.
8358
8359 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8360 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8361
8362 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8363
8364 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8365 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8366 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8367 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8368
8369 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8370 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8371 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8372 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8373
8374 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8375 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8376 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8377
8378 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8379 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8380 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8381 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8382 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8383 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8384 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8385 eight-bit-graphic.
8386
8387 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8388
8389 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8390 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8391 character set as previously.
8392
8393 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8394 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8395 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8396
8397 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8398 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8399 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8400 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8401
8402 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8403 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8404
8405 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8406 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8407 "fontset-default".
8408
8409 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8410 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8411
8412 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8413 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8414 buffers and strings.
8415
8416 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8417 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8418 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8419 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8420 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8421 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8422 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8423 also been deleted.
8424
8425 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8426 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8427 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8428
8429 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8430 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8431 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8432 may differ between buffer and string text.
8433
8434 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8435 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8436
8437 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8438 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8439 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8440 `composition' from STRING.
8441
8442 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8443 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8444
8445 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8446 obsolete.
8447
8448 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8449 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8450
8451 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8452 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8453 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8454 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8455
8456 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8457 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8458 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8459 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8460 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8461 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8462
8463 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8464 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8465 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8466
8467 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8468 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8469 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8470
8471 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8472 have been introduced.
8473
8474 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8475 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8476 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8477 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8478 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8479 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8480 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8481 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8482 their multibyte equivalent.
8483
8484 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8485 that offset in the file before writing.
8486
8487 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8488 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8489
8490 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8491 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8492 from which the command was issued.
8493
8494 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8495 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8496 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8497 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8498 operate on.
8499
8500 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8501 to `window-buffer-height'.
8502
8503 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8504
8505 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8506 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8507 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8508
8509 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8510 respectively.
8511
8512 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8513 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8514
8515 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8516 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8517 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8518
8519 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8520 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8521 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8522 is currently displayed in some window.
8523
8524 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8525 argument function's results.
8526
8527 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8528 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8529 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8530 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8531 sequence).
8532
8533 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8534 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8535
8536 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8537 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8538
8539 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8540 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8541 as follows:
8542
8543 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8544 nil don't display a cursor
8545 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8546 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8547 others display a box cursor.
8548
8549 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8550 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8551 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8552 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8553
8554 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8555 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8556 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8557 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8558
8559 Example:
8560
8561 (string-to-syntax "()")
8562 => (4 . 41)
8563
8564 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8565 other than 10.
8566
8567 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8568 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8569
8570 #b1111
8571 => 15
8572 #b-1111
8573 => -15
8574
8575 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8576
8577 #o666
8578 => 438
8579
8580 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8581
8582 #xbeef
8583 => 48815
8584
8585 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8586
8587 #2R-111
8588 => -7
8589 #25rah
8590 => 267
8591
8592 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8593 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8594 and isn't a string.
8595
8596 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8597 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8598 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8599 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8600
8601 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8602
8603 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8604 for a regexp in a string.
8605
8606 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8607 `mouse-position-function'.
8608
8609 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8610 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8611
8612 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8613 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8614
8615 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8616 returns it.
8617
8618 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8619 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8620
8621 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8622 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8623 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8624 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8625 mode.
8626
8627 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8628 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8629
8630 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8631 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8632 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8633 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8634 been performed."
8635
8636 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8637 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8638 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8639 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8640
8641 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8642 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8643 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8644
8645 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8646 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8647 specified table.
8648
8649 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8650
8651 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8652 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8653 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8654 what BODY returns.
8655
8656 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8657 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8658 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8659 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8660 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8661
8662 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8663 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8664
8665 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8666 instead of being optional.
8667
8668 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8669 modify read-only text.
8670
8671 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8672
8673 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8674 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8675 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8676 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8677 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8678
8679 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8680 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8681 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8682 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8683 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8684 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8685 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8686
8687 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8688 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8689 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8690 start sequences.
8691
8692 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8693 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8694
8695 ** New function `propertize'
8696
8697 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8698 strings with text properties.
8699
8700 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8701
8702 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8703 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8704 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8705 specified value of that property. Example:
8706
8707 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8708
8709 ** push and pop macros.
8710
8711 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8712 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8713 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8714
8715 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8716 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8717 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8718
8719 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8720
8721 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8722 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8723
8724 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8725 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8726 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8727 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8728
8729 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8730 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8731 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8732 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8733
8734 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8735 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8736 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8737 or a sign.
8738
8739 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8740 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8741 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8742 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8743 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8744 space, and DEL.
8745 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8746 and DEL.
8747 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8748 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8749 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8750 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8751 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8752 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8753 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8754 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8755 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8756 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8757 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8758 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8759 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8760 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8761 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8762
8763 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8764
8765 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8766
8767 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8768
8769 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8770 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8771
8772 :test TEST
8773
8774 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8775 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8776 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8777
8778 :size SIZE
8779
8780 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8781 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8782
8783 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8784
8785 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8786 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8787 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8788 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8789 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8790
8791 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8792
8793 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8794 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8795 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8796
8797 :weakness WEAK
8798
8799 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8800 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8801 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8802 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8803 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8804
8805 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8806
8807 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8808
8809 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8810
8811 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8812
8813 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8814
8815 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8816 values are shared.
8817
8818 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8819
8820 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8821
8822 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8823
8824 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8825
8826 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8827
8828 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8829
8830 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8831
8832 Returns the size of TABLE.
8833
8834 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8835
8836 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8837
8838 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8839
8840 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8841
8842 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8843
8844 Clear TABLE.
8845
8846 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8847
8848 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8849 not found.
8850
8851 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8852
8853 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8854 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8855
8856 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8857
8858 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8859
8860 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8861
8862 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8863 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8864
8865 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8866
8867 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8868
8869 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8870
8871 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8872 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8873 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8874 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8875 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8876
8877 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8878
8879 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8880 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8881 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8882
8883 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8884 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8885
8886 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8887 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8888
8889 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8890 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8891
8892 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8893 'case-fold-string-hash))
8894
8895 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8896
8897 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8898
8899 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8900 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8901 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8902
8903 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8904
8905 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8906 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8907
8908 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8909 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8910 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8911 is too short to reach that column.
8912
8913 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8914 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8915 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8916 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8917
8918 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8919 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8920 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8921
8922 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8923 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8924
8925 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8926 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8927
8928 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8929 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8930 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8931 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8932 temporary-file-directory instead.
8933
8934 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8935 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8936 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8937 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8938
8939 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8940 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8941
8942 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8943
8944 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8945 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8946 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8947
8948 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8949
8950 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8951 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8952 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8953 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8954 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8955 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8956
8957 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8958 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8959 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8960 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8961
8962 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8963
8964 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8965 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8966 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8967 result string.
8968
8969 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8970 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8971
8972 Example:
8973
8974 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8975 (s2 "world"))
8976 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8977 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8978 (format s1 s2))
8979
8980 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8981
8982 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8983
8984 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8985 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8986 argument in it.
8987
8988 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8989 (arg "world"))
8990 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8991 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8992 (message msg arg))
8993
8994 ** Sound support
8995
8996 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8997 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8998
8999 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
9000 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
9001 to enable sound support.
9002
9003 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
9004 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
9005 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
9006 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
9007 sound to play, before playing the sound.
9008
9009 The following sound properties are supported:
9010
9011 - `:file FILE'
9012
9013 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
9014 searched relative to `data-directory'.
9015
9016 - `:data DATA'
9017
9018 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
9019 may be present, but not both.
9020
9021 - `:volume VOLUME'
9022
9023 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
9024 0..1. This property is optional.
9025
9026 - `:device DEVICE'
9027
9028 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
9029 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
9030
9031 Other properties are ignored.
9032
9033 An alternative interface is called as
9034 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
9035
9036 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
9037
9038 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
9039 a keyword symbol.
9040
9041 ** Changes to garbage collection
9042
9043 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
9044 of live and free strings.
9045
9046 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
9047 strings that have been consed so far.
9048
9049 \f
9050 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
9051 Lisp Manual
9052
9053 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
9054 mini-windows.
9055
9056 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
9057 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
9058 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
9059
9060 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
9061
9062 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
9063
9064 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
9065 image.
9066
9067 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
9068
9069 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
9070
9071 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
9072 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
9073 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
9074 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
9075 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
9076
9077 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
9078 has a mask bitmap.
9079
9080 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
9081
9082 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
9083 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
9084 or omitted means use the selected frame.
9085
9086 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
9087 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
9088
9089 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
9090 optional.
9091
9092 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
9093 below).
9094
9095 \f
9096 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9097
9098 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9099 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9100
9101 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9102 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9103 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9104 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9105 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9106 just display it black instead.
9107
9108 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9109 a line like
9110
9111 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9112
9113 in your `.emacs'.
9114
9115 ** New face implementation.
9116
9117 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9118 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9119
9120 *** New faces.
9121
9122 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9123
9124 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9125
9126 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9127 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9128
9129 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9130
9131 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9132
9133 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9134
9135 6. Foreground color.
9136
9137 7. Background color.
9138
9139 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9140
9141 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9142
9143 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9144
9145 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9146
9147 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9148 color.
9149
9150 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9151 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9152
9153 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9154 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9155 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9156 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9157 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9158 attributes mentioned above.
9159
9160 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9161 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9162 created frames.
9163
9164 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9165 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9166 `fully-specified'.
9167
9168 *** Face merging.
9169
9170 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9171 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9172 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9173 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9174 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9175 results in a fully-specified face.
9176
9177 *** Face realization.
9178
9179 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9180 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9181 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9182 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9183 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9184 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9185
9186 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9187 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9188 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9189 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9190
9191 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9192 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9193 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9194 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9195 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9196
9197 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9198 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9199 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9200 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9201 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9202 Emacs.
9203
9204 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9205 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9206 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9207 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9208
9209 **** Clearing face caches.
9210
9211 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9212 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9213 unused fonts.
9214
9215 *** Font selection.
9216
9217 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9218 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9219 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9220
9221 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9222 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9223 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9224 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9225 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9226
9227 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9228 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9229 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9230
9231 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9232
9233 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9234 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9235 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9236 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9237 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9238 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9239 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9240
9241 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9242 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9243 doesn't exist.
9244
9245 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9246 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9247 registry.
9248
9249 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9250 slightly different.
9251
9252 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9253
9254
9255 **** Scalable fonts
9256
9257 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9258 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9259 servers.
9260
9261 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9262 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9263 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9264 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9265 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9266 that list. Example:
9267
9268 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9269
9270 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9271
9272 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9273
9274 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9275
9276 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9277 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9278 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9279
9280 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9281 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9282 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9283 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9284 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9285 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9286 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9287 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9288 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9289 of the face font sort order.
9290
9291 - Function: x-font-family-list
9292
9293 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9294 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9295 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9296 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9297
9298 - Variable: font-list-limit
9299
9300 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9301 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9302 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9303
9304 *** Setting face attributes.
9305
9306 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9307 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9308 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9309 `face-attribute'.
9310
9311 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9312 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9313
9314 The following attributes are recognized:
9315
9316 `:family'
9317
9318 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9319 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9320 and `?' are allowed.
9321
9322 `:width'
9323
9324 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9325 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9326 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9327 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9328
9329 `:height'
9330
9331 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9332 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9333 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9334 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9335
9336 `:weight'
9337
9338 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9339 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9340 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9341
9342 `:slant'
9343
9344 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9345 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9346 `reverse-oblique'.
9347
9348 `:foreground', `:background'
9349
9350 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9351
9352 `:underline'
9353
9354 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9355 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9356 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9357 don't underline.
9358
9359 `:overline'
9360
9361 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9362 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9363 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9364 overline.
9365
9366 `:strike-through'
9367
9368 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9369 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9370 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9371 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9372
9373 `:box'
9374
9375 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9376 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9377 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9378 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9379 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9380 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9381 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9382 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9383 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9384 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9385 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9386 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9387 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9388 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9389 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9390 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9391 box.
9392
9393 `:inverse-video'
9394
9395 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9396 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9397
9398 `:stipple'
9399
9400 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9401 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9402 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9403 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9404 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9405 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9406
9407 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9408 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9409
9410 `:font'
9411
9412 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9413 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9414 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9415 versions of Emacs.
9416
9417 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9418 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9419 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9420
9421 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9422 `defface'.
9423
9424 `:inherit'
9425
9426 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9427 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9428 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9429
9430 *** Face attributes and X resources
9431
9432 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9433 from X resources:
9434
9435 Face attribute X resource class
9436 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9437 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9438 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9439 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9440 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9441 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9442 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9443 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9444 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9445 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9446 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9447 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9448 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9449 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9450 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9451 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9452 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9453 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9454 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9455 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9456
9457 *** Text property `face'.
9458
9459 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9460 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9461 specification can be
9462
9463 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9464
9465 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9466 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9467 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9468 for face attribute names.
9469
9470 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9471 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9472 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9473
9474 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9475
9476 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9477 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9478 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9479 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9480 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9481 used to clear the mapping table.
9482
9483 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9484
9485 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9486 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9487 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9488 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9489 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9490 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9491 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9492 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9493 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9494 modify their color-related behavior.
9495
9496 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9497 any frame type.
9498
9499 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9500
9501 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9502 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9503 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9504 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9505 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9506 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9507 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9508 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9509 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9510
9511 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9512 display can display image files.
9513
9514 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9515
9516 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9517 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9518 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9519 `Inviolable' option.
9520
9521 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9522 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9523 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9524
9525 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9526
9527 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9528 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9529 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9530
9531 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9532 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9533 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9534 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9535 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9536 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9537 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9538 functions.
9539
9540 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9541 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9542 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9543
9544 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9545
9546 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9547
9548 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9549
9550 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9551 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9552 constrained position if that is different.
9553
9554 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9555 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9556 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9557 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9558 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9559 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9560 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9561 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9562 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9563
9564 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9565 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9566 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9567 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9568 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9569
9570 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9571 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9572
9573 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9574
9575 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9576
9577 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9578 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9579 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9580
9581 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9582
9583 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9584 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9585 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9586 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9587 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9588
9589 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9590
9591 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9592 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9593 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9594 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9595 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9596
9597 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9598
9599 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9600 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9601 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9602
9603 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9604
9605 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9606 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9607 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9608
9609 ** Image support.
9610
9611 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9612 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9613 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9614 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9615
9616 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9617 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9618 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9619 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9620 area.
9621
9622 IMAGE is an image specification.
9623
9624 *** Image specifications
9625
9626 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9627 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9628 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9629 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9630 described below are ignored.
9631
9632 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9633
9634 `:ascent ASCENT'
9635
9636 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9637 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9638 to use for its ascent.
9639
9640 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9641 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9642
9643 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9644 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9645 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9646 overlays that apply to the image.
9647
9648 `:margin MARGIN'
9649
9650 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9651 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9652 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9653
9654 `:relief RELIEF'
9655
9656 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9657 around an image.
9658
9659 `:conversion ALGO'
9660
9661 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9662
9663 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9664 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9665
9666 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9667 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9668 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9669 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9670 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9671 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9672 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9673 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9674 below.
9675
9676 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9677 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9678 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9679
9680 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9681 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9682 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9683 of the factors' absolute values.
9684
9685 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9686
9687 (1 0 0
9688 0 0 0
9689 9 9 -1)
9690
9691 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9692
9693 ( 2 -1 0
9694 -1 0 1
9695 0 1 -2)
9696
9697 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9698 ``disabled''.
9699
9700 `:mask MASK'
9701
9702 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9703 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9704 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9705 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9706 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9707 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9708 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9709 image.
9710
9711 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9712 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9713 `:mask nil'.
9714
9715 `:file FILE'
9716
9717 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9718 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9719 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9720 may be present in the image specification.
9721
9722 `:data DATA'
9723
9724 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9725 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9726 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9727 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9728
9729 *** Supported image types
9730
9731 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9732
9733 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9734 properties supported are:
9735
9736 `:foreground FG'
9737
9738 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9739 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9740
9741 `:background BG'
9742
9743 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9744 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9745
9746 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9747 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9748 instead of a `:file' property.
9749
9750 `:width WIDTH'
9751
9752 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9753
9754 `:height HEIGHT'
9755
9756 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9757
9758 `:data DATA'
9759
9760 DATA must be either
9761
9762 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9763 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9764
9765 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9766
9767 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9768 bitmap.
9769
9770 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9771 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9772 in the file.
9773
9774 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9775
9776 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9777 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9778 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9779 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9780
9781 Additional image properties supported are:
9782
9783 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9784
9785 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9786 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9787 name.
9788
9789 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9790 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9791
9792 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9793 to display compressed images.
9794
9795 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9796
9797 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9798 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9799 mono images are:
9800
9801 `:foreground FG'
9802
9803 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9804 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9805
9806 `:background FG'
9807
9808 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9809 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9810
9811 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9812
9813 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9814 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9815 properties defined.
9816
9817 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9818
9819 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9820 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9821 properties defined.
9822
9823 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9824
9825 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9826 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9827
9828 Additional image properties supported are:
9829
9830 `:index INDEX'
9831
9832 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9833 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9834 as a hollow box.
9835
9836 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9837 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9838 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9839 every 0.1 seconds.
9840
9841 (defun show-anim (file max)
9842 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9843 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9844
9845 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9846 (when (= idx max)
9847 (setq idx 0))
9848 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9849 (save-excursion
9850 (set-buffer buffer)
9851 (goto-char (point-min))
9852 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9853 (insert-image img "x"))
9854 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9855
9856 **** PNG, image type `png'
9857
9858 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9859 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9860 properties defined.
9861
9862 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9863
9864 Additional image properties supported are:
9865
9866 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9867
9868 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9869 integer. This is a required property.
9870
9871 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9872
9873 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9874 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9875
9876 `:bounding-box BOX'
9877
9878 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9879 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9880 files. This is an required property.
9881
9882 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9883 lisp/gs.el.
9884
9885 *** Lisp interface.
9886
9887 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9888 which are supported in the current configuration.
9889
9890 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9891 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9892 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9893 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9894 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9895
9896 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9897
9898 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9899 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9900 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9901 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9902 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9903 buffer.
9904
9905 ** Display margins.
9906
9907 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9908 and images.
9909
9910 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9911 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9912 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9913 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9914 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9915 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9916 of the display margins.
9917
9918 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9919 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9920 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9921 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9922 in this file).
9923
9924 ** Help display
9925
9926 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9927 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9928 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9929 that have a `help-echo' property.
9930
9931 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9932 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9933 the window in which the help was found.
9934
9935 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9936 `help-echo' text property was found.
9937
9938 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9939 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9940
9941 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9942 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9943 mouse.
9944
9945 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9946 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9947
9948 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9949 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9950 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9951 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9952 used as help string.
9953
9954 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9955 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9956 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9957
9958 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9959
9960 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9961 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9962
9963 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9964 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9965 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9966 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9967 used.
9968
9969 (global-set-key [A-down]
9970 #'(lambda ()
9971 (interactive)
9972 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9973 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9974 (global-set-key [A-up]
9975 #'(lambda ()
9976 (interactive)
9977 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9978 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9979
9980 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9981
9982 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9983 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9984 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9985 is called with one argument, POS.
9986
9987 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9988 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9989 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9990 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9991 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9992
9993 ** Tool bar support.
9994
9995 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9996 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9997 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9998 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9999 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
10000 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
10001
10002 *** Tool bar item definitions
10003
10004 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
10005 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
10006 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
10007
10008 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
10009 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
10010 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
10011 property (see below).
10012
10013 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
10014 binding are currently ignored.
10015
10016 The following properties are recognized:
10017
10018 `:enable FORM'.
10019
10020 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
10021 or disabled.
10022
10023 `:visible FORM'
10024
10025 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
10026
10027 `:filter FUNCTION'
10028
10029 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
10030 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
10031 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
10032
10033 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
10034
10035 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
10036 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
10037
10038 `:image IMAGES'
10039
10040 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
10041 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
10042 meaning of each of the four elements:
10043
10044 Index Use when item is
10045 ----------------------------------------
10046 0 enabled and selected
10047 1 enabled and deselected
10048 2 disabled and selected
10049 3 disabled and deselected
10050
10051 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
10052 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
10053
10054 `:help HELP-STRING'.
10055
10056 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
10057 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
10058
10059 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
10060 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
10061 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
10062 menu bar.
10063
10064 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
10065 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
10066 buffer-locally to override the global map.
10067
10068 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
10069
10070 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
10071 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
10072 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
10073
10074 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
10075 raised when the mouse moves over them.
10076
10077 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
10078 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
10079 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
10080 vertical margins . Default is 1.
10081
10082 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
10083 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
10084
10085 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
10086
10087 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
10088 a tool bar item. If
10089
10090 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
10091 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
10092 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
10093
10094 is the original tool bar item definition, then
10095
10096 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10097
10098 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10099 item.
10100
10101 ** Mode line changes.
10102
10103 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10104
10105 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10106 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10107 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10108
10109 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10110 a `local-map' text property.
10111
10112 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10113 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10114
10115 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10116 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10117 `local-map' property.
10118
10119 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10120 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10121 example.
10122
10123 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10124 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10125
10126 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10127 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10128
10129 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10130
10131 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10132 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10133 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10134 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10135 line.
10136
10137 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10138 `header-line'.
10139
10140 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10141 position in the header-line.
10142
10143 ** Text property `display'
10144
10145 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10146 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10147 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10148 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10149 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10150
10151 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10152
10153 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10154 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10155
10156 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10157 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10158 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10159 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10160 simpler form STRING as property value.
10161
10162 *** Variable width and height spaces
10163
10164 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10165 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10166 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10167 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10168 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10169 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10170 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10171
10172 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10173 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10174 properties described below.
10175
10176 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10177 characters having the `display' property.
10178
10179 - :width WIDTH
10180
10181 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10182 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10183
10184 - :relative-width FACTOR
10185
10186 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10187 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10188 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10189 width of that character by FACTOR.
10190
10191 - :align-to HPOS
10192
10193 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10194 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10195
10196 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10197
10198 - :height HEIGHT
10199
10200 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10201 normal line height.
10202
10203 - :relative-height FACTOR
10204
10205 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10206 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10207
10208 - :ascent ASCENT
10209
10210 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10211 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10212 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10213 equal to 100.
10214
10215 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10216
10217 *** Images
10218
10219 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10220 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10221 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10222 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10223 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10224 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10225 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10226 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10227 as display specification.
10228
10229 *** Other display properties
10230
10231 - (space-width FACTOR)
10232
10233 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10234 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10235 integer or float.
10236
10237 - (height HEIGHT)
10238
10239 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10240
10241 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10242 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10243 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10244 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10245 a font is available counts as a step.
10246
10247 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10248 as tall as the frame's default font.
10249
10250 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10251 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10252
10253 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10254 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10255
10256 - (raise FACTOR)
10257
10258 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10259 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10260 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10261 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10262 `height' subproperty.
10263
10264 *** Conditional display properties
10265
10266 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10267 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10268 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10269 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10270 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10271 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10272 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10273 different when object is a string.
10274
10275 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10276 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10277
10278 ** New menu separator types.
10279
10280 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10281 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10282 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10283 to specify other menu separator types.
10284
10285 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10286
10287 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10288 separator occurs.
10289
10290 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10291
10292 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10293
10294 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10295
10296 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10297
10298 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10299
10300 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10301
10302 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10303
10304 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10305
10306 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10307
10308 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10309 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10310
10311 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10312
10313 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10314
10315 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10316
10317 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10318
10319 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10320
10321 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10322
10323 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10324
10325 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10326
10327 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10328
10329 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10330
10331 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10332
10333 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10334
10335 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10336
10337 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10338
10339 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10340 the corresponding single-line separators.
10341
10342 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10343
10344 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10345 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10346 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10347 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10348 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10349 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10350 default foreground is black.
10351
10352 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10353 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10354 `ScrollBarBackground').
10355
10356 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10357 settings for scroll bar colors.
10358
10359 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10360 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10361
10362 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10363 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10364 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10365 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10366 the original window start.
10367
10368 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10369 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10370 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10371
10372 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10373
10374 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10375 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10376 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10377 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10378
10379 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10380 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10381
10382 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10383
10384 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10385 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10386 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10387 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10388 temporarily to nil, for example
10389
10390 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10391 (enlarge-window 10))
10392
10393 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10394 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10395
10396 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10397 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10398 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10399 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10400 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10401 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10402
10403
10404 \f
10405 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10406
10407 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10408 input.
10409
10410 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10411
10412 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10413
10414 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10415 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10416 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10417 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10418 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10419
10420 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10421 been added.
10422
10423 \f
10424 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10425
10426 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10427
10428
10429 \f
10430 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10431
10432 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10433 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10434 \f
10435 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10436
10437 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10438
10439 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10440 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10441 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10442
10443 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10444 is the one that is used.
10445
10446 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10447 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10448 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10449 separate from the command's regular output.
10450 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10451 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10452 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10453 the buffer name.
10454
10455 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10456 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10457 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10458 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10459
10460 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10461 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10462 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10463 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10464
10465 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10466 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10467 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10468 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10469
10470 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10471 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10472 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10473 they never ignore case.
10474
10475 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10476 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10477 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10478 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10479 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10480 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10481 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10482
10483 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10484 the same format that was used in the file before.
10485
10486 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10487 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10488
10489 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10490 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10491 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10492
10493 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10494 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10495 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10496 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10497 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10498 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10499 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10500
10501 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10502 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10503 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10504 format. You can now customize these variables.
10505
10506 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10507 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10508 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10509 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10510
10511 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10512 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10513 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10514
10515 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10516 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10517 doesn't have any effect.
10518
10519 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10520 not one per buffer.
10521
10522 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10523 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10524 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10525
10526 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10527 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10528 `auto-show-mode' command.
10529
10530 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10531 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10532 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10533 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10534 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10535
10536 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10537 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10538
10539 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10540 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10541 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10542
10543 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10544 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10545 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10546 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10547
10548 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10549
10550 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10551 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10552 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10553 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10554 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10555
10556 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10557 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10558
10559 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10560 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10561 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10562 `?' on other systems.
10563
10564 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10565 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10566 Unix.
10567
10568 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10569 current codepage when it starts.
10570
10571 ** Mail changes
10572
10573 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10574 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10575 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10576 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10577 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10578 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10579 latin-1:
10580
10581 MIME-version: 1.0
10582 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10583 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10584
10585 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10586 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10587 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10588 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10589 buffer-file-coding-system.
10590
10591 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10592 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10593 mail.
10594
10595 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10596 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10597 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10598 list of possible coding systems.
10599
10600 ** CC Mode changes
10601
10602 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10603 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10604 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10605 docstring for details.
10606
10607 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10608 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10609 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10610 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10611 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10612
10613 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10614 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10615
10616 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10617 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10618
10619 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10620 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10621 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10622 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10623 anonymous classes.
10624
10625 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10626 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10627
10628 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10629 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10630 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10631 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10632
10633 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10634 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10635 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10636 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10637 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10638
10639 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10640
10641 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10642
10643 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10644 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10645
10646 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10647
10648 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10649 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10650 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10651 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10652 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10653
10654 ** Gnus changes.
10655
10656 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10657 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10658 Gnus manual for the full story.
10659
10660 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10661 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10662 group, which is created automatically.
10663
10664 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10665 values.
10666
10667 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10668
10669 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10670 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10671
10672 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10673 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10674
10675 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10676
10677 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10678 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10679
10680 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10681
10682 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10683 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10684
10685 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10686 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10687
10688 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10689 control over simplification.
10690
10691 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10692
10693 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10694 limit.
10695
10696 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10697
10698 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10699
10700 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10701 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10702 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10703
10704 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10705 `a' forces normal posting method.
10706
10707 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10708 -- `W d'.
10709
10710 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10711 to a non-nil value.
10712
10713 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10714 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10715
10716 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10717 has been added.
10718
10719 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10720
10721 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10722
10723 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10724 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10725
10726 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10727 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10728
10729 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10730
10731 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10732 been added.
10733
10734 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10735 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10736
10737 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10738 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10739
10740 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10741
10742 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10743
10744 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10745
10746 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10747
10748 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10749 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10750 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10751
10752 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10753 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10754 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10755 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10756 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10757
10758 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10759 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10760 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10761 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10762
10763 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10764 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10765 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10766 mismatch.
10767
10768 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10769
10770 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10771 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10772
10773 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10774 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10775 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10776 removed from the label.
10777
10778 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10779 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10780
10781 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10782 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10783
10784 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10785 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10786 expressions.
10787
10788 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10789
10790 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10791
10792 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10793 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10794
10795 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10796 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10797 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10798
10799 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10800 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10801 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10802 \f
10803 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10804
10805 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10806 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10807 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10808 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10809 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10810
10811 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10812 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10813 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10814
10815 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10816 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10817 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10818 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10819 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10820 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10821 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10822 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10823 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10824
10825 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10826 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10827 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10828 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10829 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10830 program.
10831
10832 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10833 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10834 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10835 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10836 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10837 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10838
10839 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10840 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10841 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10842 was not documented clearly before.
10843
10844 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10845 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10846 \f
10847 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10848
10849 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10850 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10851 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10852 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10853
10854 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10855 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10856 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10857
10858 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10859
10860 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10861 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10862
10863 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10864 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10865 integers.
10866
10867 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10868 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10869 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10870 file names and attributes are returned.
10871
10872 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10873 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10874 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10875 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10876 returns the result.
10877
10878 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10879 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10880
10881 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10882
10883 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10884 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10885 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10886 optionally.
10887
10888 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10889 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10890
10891 **
10892 The new function process-running-child-p
10893 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10894 terminal to its own child process.
10895
10896 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10897 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10898 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10899 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10900
10901 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10902 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10903
10904 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10905 :included is an alias for :visible.
10906
10907 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10908 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10909 to move or copy menu entries.
10910
10911 ** Multibyte editing changes
10912
10913 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10914 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10915 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10916 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10917 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10918 (setq char (sref str idx)
10919 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10920 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10921
10922 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10923 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10924 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10925
10926 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10927 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10928 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10929
10930 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10931
10932 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10933 across the boundary.
10934
10935 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10936 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10937 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10938 contains 8-bit characters.
10939 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10940 contains invalid characters.
10941
10942 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10943 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10944 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10945 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10946 way.
10947
10948 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10949 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10950 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10951 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10952
10953 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10954 compose Thai characters in a string.
10955
10956 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10957 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10958 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10959 menus should always use the third argument.
10960
10961 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10962 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10963 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10964 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10965
10966 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10967 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10968 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10969 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10970
10971 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10972 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10973 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10974 echo area contents.
10975
10976 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10977
10978 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10979 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10980 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10981
10982 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10983 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10984 means to clear out that attribute.
10985
10986 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10987 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10988
10989 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10990 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10991 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10992 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10993
10994 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10995 the gap of the current buffer.
10996
10997 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10998 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10999 current buffer.
11000
11001 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
11002 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
11003 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
11004 it back in after any modifications have been made.
11005 \f
11006 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
11007
11008 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
11009 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
11010 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
11011 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
11012 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
11013
11014 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
11015 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
11016 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
11017 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
11018 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
11019
11020 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
11021 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
11022 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
11023
11024 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
11025 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
11026 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
11027 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
11028 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
11029 results.
11030
11031 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
11032 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
11033 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
11034 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
11035 \f
11036 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
11037
11038 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
11039 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
11040 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
11041 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
11042
11043 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
11044 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
11045 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
11046 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
11047 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
11048 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
11049 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
11050 region.
11051
11052 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
11053 selective undo.
11054
11055 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
11056 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
11057 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
11058 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
11059 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
11060
11061 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
11062 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
11063 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
11064 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
11065
11066 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
11067 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
11068 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
11069 something that most users not do.
11070
11071 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
11072 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
11073 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
11074 applications.
11075
11076 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
11077 pasting operations.
11078
11079 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
11080 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
11081 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
11082 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
11083 `ps-printer-name'.
11084
11085 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
11086 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
11087 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
11088 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
11089 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
11090 hits a new word.
11091
11092 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11093 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11094 to be confused by TeX commands.
11095
11096 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11097 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11098 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11099 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11100
11101 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11102 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11103 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11104 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11105 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11106
11107 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11108 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11109
11110 ** Changes in input method usage.
11111
11112 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11113 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11114 respectively.
11115
11116 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11117
11118 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11119 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11120
11121 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11122 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11123
11124 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11125
11126 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11127
11128 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11129 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11130
11131 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11132 given in the following case:
11133 o When you are using a complex input method.
11134 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11135
11136 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11137 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11138 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11139 setting it to t is helpful.
11140
11141 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11142
11143 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11144 keys:
11145 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11146 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11147 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11148 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11149 environment.
11150
11151 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11152 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11153 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11154 get
11155
11156 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11157
11158 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11159
11160 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11161 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11162
11163 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11164 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11165 its owner and group.
11166
11167 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11168 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11169
11170 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11171 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11172
11173 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11174 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11175 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11176 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11177
11178 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11179 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11180 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11181 for writing keyboard macros.
11182
11183 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11184 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11185 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11186 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11187 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11188 info.
11189
11190 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11191
11192 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11193 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11194 contents only.
11195
11196 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11197 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11198 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11199 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11200
11201 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11202 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11203 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11204
11205 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11206 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11207 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11208 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11209
11210 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11211 failure if the command produces no output.
11212
11213 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11214 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11215 the mouse.
11216
11217 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11218 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11219 function and variable names.
11220
11221 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11222 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11223 file-coding-system-alist.
11224
11225 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11226 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11227 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11228 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11229 according to the current fontset.
11230
11231 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11232
11233 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11234 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11235 nonascii-insert-offset.
11236
11237 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11238 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11239 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11240 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11241
11242 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11243 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11244
11245 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11246 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11247
11248 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11249 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11250 command keys.
11251
11252 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11253 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11254
11255 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11256 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11257 all variables that have documentation.
11258
11259 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11260 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11261 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11262 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11263 it should show; the default is 20.
11264
11265 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11266 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11267 of your input.
11268
11269 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11270 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11271 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11272 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11273 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11274 Newly added options are included as well.
11275
11276 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11277 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11278 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11279
11280 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11281 Customize menu.
11282
11283 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11284 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11285
11286 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11287 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11288 invoked.
11289
11290 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11291 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11292 The default is 1.
11293
11294 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11295 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11296 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11297 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11298 sensibly.
11299
11300 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11301
11302 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11303 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11304 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11305
11306 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11307 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11308 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11309 every night.
11310
11311 ** Desktop changes
11312
11313 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11314 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11315
11316 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11317 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11318
11319 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11320 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11321
11322 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11323 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11324 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11325 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11326 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11327 made invisible again.
11328
11329 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11330
11331 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11332 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11333 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11334 toggle.
11335
11336 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11337 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11338 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11339 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11340 rmail-default-body-file.
11341
11342 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11343 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11344 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11345
11346 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11347 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11348 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11349
11350 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11351 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11352 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11353 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11354 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11355 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11356
11357 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11358 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11359 provided by feedmail are:
11360
11361 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11362 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11363 there is also a queue for draft messages
11364
11365 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11366 be prompted for confirmation
11367
11368 **** does smart filling of address headers
11369
11370 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11371 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11372 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11373
11374 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11375 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11376 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11377 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11378
11379 ** Dired changes
11380
11381 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11382 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11383
11384 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11385 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11386
11387 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11388 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11389 for a specified regexp.
11390
11391 ** VC Changes
11392
11393 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11394 conveniently.
11395
11396 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11397 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11398 Dired.
11399
11400 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11401 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11402 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11403 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11404
11405 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11406 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11407 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11408 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11409 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11410
11411 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11412 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11413 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11414 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11415 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11416
11417 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11418 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11419 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11420 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11421
11422 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11423 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11424 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11425
11426 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11427 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11428 session to resolve them.
11429
11430 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11431 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11432 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11433 uses as well).
11434
11435 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11436 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11437 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11438 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11439 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11440 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11441 using ediff.
11442
11443 ** Changes in Font Lock
11444
11445 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11446 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11447 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11448 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11449 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11450
11451 ** Frame name display changes
11452
11453 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11454 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11455 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11456 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11457
11458 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11459 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11460 menu.
11461
11462 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11463
11464 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11465 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11466 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11467
11468 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11469
11470 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11471 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11472 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11473
11474 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11475 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11476 the following line.
11477
11478 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11479 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11480 previously sent input.
11481
11482 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11483 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11484 as the search string.
11485
11486 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11487 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11488
11489 ** C mode changes
11490
11491 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11492 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11493 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11494 definition.
11495
11496 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11497 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11498 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11499 style is still the default however.
11500
11501 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11502
11503 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11504 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11505 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11506
11507 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11508 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11509
11510 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11511 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11512
11513 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11514 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11515
11516 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11517 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11518
11519 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11520 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11521 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11522 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11523
11524 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11525
11526 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11527 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11528 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11529
11530 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11531 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11532 expanding dynamically.
11533
11534 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11535 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11536
11537 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11538 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11539 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11540 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11541
11542 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11543
11544 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11545
11546 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11547 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11548 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11549 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11550 against the first word in the title.
11551
11552 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11553 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11554 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11555 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11556 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11557 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11558
11559 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11560 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11561 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11562 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11563
11564 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11565
11566 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11567 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11568 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11569 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11570 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11571 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11572
11573 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11574 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11575
11576 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11577 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11578 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11579
11580 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11581 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11582
11583 ** Ispell changes.
11584
11585 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11586 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11587 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11588
11589 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11590 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11591 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11592 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11593 include:
11594
11595 o URLs are automatically skipped
11596 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11597
11598 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11599
11600 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11601
11602 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11603 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11604 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11605 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11606
11607 *** New recursive parser.
11608
11609 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11610 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11611 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11612
11613 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11614
11615 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11616 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11617 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11618
11619 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11620
11621 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11622
11623 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11624
11625 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11626
11627 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11628
11629 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11630 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11631
11632 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11633
11634 *** References to external documents.
11635
11636 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11637 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11638 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11639 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11640 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11641 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11642 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11643
11644 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11645
11646 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11647 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11648
11649 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11650 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11651
11652 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11653
11654 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11655 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11656
11657 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11658
11659 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11660 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11661 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11662 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11663 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11664 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11665 more.
11666
11667 *** Support for the varioref package
11668
11669 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11670
11671 *** New hooks
11672
11673 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11674 and citations are created. These hooks are
11675 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11676 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11677
11678 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11679
11680 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11681 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11682
11683 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11684
11685 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11686 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11687 fontified, use
11688
11689 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11690
11691 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11692 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11693 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11694 directories that contain the same file name.
11695
11696 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11697 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11698 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11699 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11700 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11701 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11702 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11703 directory.
11704
11705 ** New modes and packages
11706
11707 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11708 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11709 it, but some do not.
11710
11711 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11712 code.
11713
11714 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11715 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11716 around in a buffer.
11717
11718 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11719
11720 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11721 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11722 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11723 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11724
11725 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11726 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11727 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11728
11729 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11730 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11731 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11732 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11733 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11734 the like.
11735
11736 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11737 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11738
11739 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11740 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11741 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11742 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11743
11744 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11745
11746 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11747 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11748 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11749 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11750 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11751 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11752 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11753 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11754 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11755 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11756 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11757
11758 Platform-specific modes:
11759
11760 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11761 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11762 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11763 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11764 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11765 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11766 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11767 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11768 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11769 \f
11770 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11771
11772 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11773 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11774 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11775 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11776
11777 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11778 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11779 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11780
11781 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11782 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11783 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11784 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11785
11786 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11787 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11788 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11789 environment.
11790
11791 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11792 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11793 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11794 current input method for reading this one event.
11795
11796 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11797 now control whether to output certain characters as
11798 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11799 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11800 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11801 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11802 \f
11803 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11804
11805 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11806 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11807
11808 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11809 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11810 always increases point by 1.
11811
11812 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11813 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11814
11815 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11816
11817 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11818 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11819 default value changed. For example,
11820
11821 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11822 :type 'integer
11823 :group 'foo
11824 :version "20.3")
11825
11826 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11827 :version "20.3")
11828
11829 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11830 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11831 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11832 `:version' in the top level group.
11833
11834 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11835
11836 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11837 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11838
11839 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11840 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11841 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11842 to themselves.
11843
11844 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11845 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11846 values whatever.
11847
11848 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11849 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11850 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11851
11852 ** Frame-local variables.
11853
11854 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11855 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11856 local bindings for that variable.
11857
11858 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11859 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11860 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11861 parameter name.
11862
11863 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11864 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11865 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11866 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11867
11868 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11869 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11870 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11871 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11872
11873 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11874 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11875 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11876 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11877 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11878
11879 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11880 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11881 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11882 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11883
11884 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11885 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11886
11887 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11888 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11889 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11890
11891 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11892 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11893 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11894 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11895
11896 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11897 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11898 empty input.
11899
11900 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11901 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11902 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11903 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11904 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11905
11906 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11907 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11908 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11909 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11910
11911 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11912 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11913 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11914 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11915 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11916
11917 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11918 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11919 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11920 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11921
11922 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11923 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11924 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11925
11926 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11927 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11928 was directed to display this buffer.
11929
11930 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11931 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11932 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11933 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11934 set-window-configuration.
11935
11936 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11937 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11938 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11939 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11940
11941 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11942 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11943 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11944
11945 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11946 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11947 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11948
11949 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11950 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11951
11952 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11953 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11954
11955 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11956 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11957 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11958
11959 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11960 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11961 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11962 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11963
11964 ** Menu changes
11965
11966 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11967 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11968 better supported.
11969
11970 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11971 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11972 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11973 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11974 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11975
11976 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11977
11978 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11979 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11980 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11981 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11982
11983 The format is:
11984 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11985 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11986 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11987 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11988 The supported properties include
11989
11990 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11991 item is enabled.
11992 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11993 item should appear in the menu.
11994 :filter FILTER-FN
11995 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11996 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11997 It should return a binding to use instead.
11998 :keys DESCRIPTION
11999 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
12000 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
12001 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
12002 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
12003 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
12004 keyboard binding.
12005 :key-sequence nil
12006 This means that the command normally has no
12007 keyboard equivalent.
12008 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
12009 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
12010 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
12011 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
12012 value says whether this button is currently selected.
12013
12014 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
12015 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
12016
12017 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
12018
12019 ** New event types
12020
12021 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
12022 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
12023 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
12024 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
12025
12026 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
12027
12028 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12029 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
12030 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
12031 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
12032 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
12033 forward, away from the user.
12034
12035 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12036
12037 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
12038 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
12039 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
12040 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
12041 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
12042
12043 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
12044
12045 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12046 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
12047 that were dragged and dropped.
12048
12049 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12050
12051 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
12052
12053 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
12054 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
12055 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
12056
12057 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
12058 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
12059 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
12060
12061 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
12062 in Emacs 19 and before.
12063
12064 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
12065 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
12066
12067 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
12068 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
12069 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
12070 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
12071
12072 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
12073 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
12074 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
12075 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
12076 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
12077
12078 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
12079 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
12080 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
12081 consistent with the new representation.
12082
12083 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
12084 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
12085 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
12086 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12087
12088 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
12089 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
12090 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
12091
12092 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12093 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12094 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12095
12096 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12097 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12098 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12099
12100 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12101 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12102
12103 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12104 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12105
12106 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12107 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12108 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12109 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12110
12111 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12112 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12113
12114 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12115 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12116 buffer or string being searched.
12117
12118 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12119 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12120 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12121 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12122 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12123 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12124 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12125
12126 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12127
12128 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12129 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12130 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12131 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12132 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12133 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12134 define-coding-system-alias.
12135
12136 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12137 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12138 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12139 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12140 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12141 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12142 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12143 `iso-8859-1'.
12144
12145 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12146 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12147 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12148 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12149
12150 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12151 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12152 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12153 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12154
12155 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12156 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12157 This function requires a user interaction.
12158
12159 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12160 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12161 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12162 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12163 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12164 select-safe-coding-system.
12165
12166 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12167 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12168 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12169 was done.
12170
12171 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12172 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12173 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12174
12175 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12176 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12177 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12178 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12179
12180 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12181 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12182 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12183 converted.
12184
12185 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12186 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12187
12188 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12189 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12190 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12191 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12192 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12193 range of characters.
12194
12195 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12196 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12197
12198 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12199 in the current buffer at position POS.
12200
12201 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12202 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12203 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12204 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12205 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12206 binding input-method-function to nil.
12207
12208 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12209 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12210 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12211 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12212 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12213
12214 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12215 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12216
12217 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12218 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12219
12220 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12221 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12222 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12223 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12224 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12225 \f
12226 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12227
12228 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12229 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12230 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12231 tree structure.
12232
12233 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12234 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12235
12236 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12237 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12238 in your .emacs file.)
12239
12240 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12241 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12242
12243 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12244 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12245
12246 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12247 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12248 kills the region.
12249
12250 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12251 delete the character before point, as usual.
12252
12253 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12254 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12255 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12256
12257 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12258 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12259 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12260 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12261 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12262 past.)
12263
12264 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12265 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12266 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12267 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12268 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12269
12270 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12271 and is an alias for it.
12272
12273 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12274 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12275
12276 ** Scrolling changes
12277
12278 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12279 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12280
12281 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12282 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12283 where it started.
12284
12285 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12286 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12287 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12288 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12289
12290 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12291 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12292 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12293 recenters the window.
12294
12295 ** International character set support (MULE)
12296
12297 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12298 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12299 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12300 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12301 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12302 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12303
12304 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12305 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12306 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12307 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12308 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12309
12310 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12311 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12312 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12313 language, to make it possible to type them.
12314
12315 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12316 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12317
12318 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12319 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12320
12321 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12322
12323 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12324
12325 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12326 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12327 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12328 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12329 characters for their work until they want to change.
12330
12331 *** Input methods
12332
12333 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12334 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12335 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12336 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12337 support several input methods.
12338
12339 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12340 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12341 work.
12342
12343 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12344 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12345 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12346 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12347 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12348 letter.
12349
12350 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12351 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12352 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12353 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12354 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12355
12356 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12357 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12358 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12359 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12360
12361 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12362 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12363 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12364 the first guess is wrong.
12365
12366 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12367 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12368
12369 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12370 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12371 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12372 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12373
12374 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12375 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12376 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12377 translate automatically to and from either one.
12378
12379 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12380
12381 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12382 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12383 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12384 what you want.
12385
12386 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12387 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12388 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12389 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12390
12391 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12392 character conversion as well.
12393
12394 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12395
12396 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12397 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12398 requires using many fonts.
12399
12400 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12401 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12402
12403 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12404 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12405 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12406 you would use a font.
12407
12408 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12409 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12410 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12411
12412 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12413 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12414 characters).
12415
12416 *** Defining fontsets.
12417
12418 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12419 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12420 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12421
12422 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12423 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12424 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12425 standard fontset are created automatically.
12426
12427 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12428 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12429 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12430 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12431 name is `fontset-startup'.
12432
12433 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12434 The resource value should have this form:
12435 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12436 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12437 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12438 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12439 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12440 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12441 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12442 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12443 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12444
12445 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12446 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12447 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12448
12449 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12450 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12451 following resource,
12452 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12453 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12454 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12455 Here is the substitution rule:
12456 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12457 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12458 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12459 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12460 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12461
12462 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12463 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12464 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12465
12466 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12467 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12468 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12469 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12470 fontsets.
12471
12472 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12473 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12474
12475 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12476 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12477 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12478 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12479 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12480 system for new files that you create.
12481
12482 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12483 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12484 whole Emacs session.
12485
12486 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12487 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12488 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12489
12490 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12491 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12492 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12493 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12494 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12495
12496 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12497 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12498 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12499 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12500 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12501
12502 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12503 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12504
12505 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12506 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12507
12508 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12509 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12510
12511 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12512 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12513 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12514 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12515 of the file.
12516
12517 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12518 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12519 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12520 translated into that character code.
12521
12522 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12523 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12524
12525 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12526
12527 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12528 the coding system for keyboard input.
12529
12530 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12531 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12532 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12533
12534 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12535
12536 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12537 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12538 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12539 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12540 designed to work with terminals.
12541
12542 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12543 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12544 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12545 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12546 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12547 in the corresponding buffer.
12548
12549 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12550
12551 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12552 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12553 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12554
12555 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12556 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12557 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12558 want to use.
12559
12560 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12561 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12562
12563 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12564 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12565 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12566 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12567
12568 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12569 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12570 related information.
12571
12572 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12573 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12574 scripts.
12575
12576 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12577 information about the support for a particular language.
12578 You specify the language as an argument.
12579
12580 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12581 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12582 first dash.
12583
12584 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12585 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12586 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12587 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12588
12589 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12590 B big5 (Chinese)
12591 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12592 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12593 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12594 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12595 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12596 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12597 K euc-korea (Korean)
12598 R koi8 (Russian)
12599 Q tibetan
12600 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12601 T lao
12602 T tis620 (Thai)
12603 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12604 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12605 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12606 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12607 z hz (Chinese)
12608
12609 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12610 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12611 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12612 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12613
12614 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12615 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12616
12617 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12618 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12619 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12620 Rmail files themselves.
12621
12622 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12623 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12624
12625 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12626 for sending mail:
12627
12628 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12629 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12630 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12631 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12632 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12633
12634 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12635 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12636 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12637 translations.
12638
12639 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12640 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12641 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12642 without any conversion.
12643
12644 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12645 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12646 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12647 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12648
12649 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12650 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12651
12652 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12653 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12654
12655 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12656 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12657
12658 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12659 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12660 in the buffer before point.
12661
12662 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12663 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12664 you are using.
12665
12666 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12667 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12668
12669 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12670
12671 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12672 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12673
12674 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12675 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12676 can become a bottleneck.
12677
12678 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12679 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12680 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12681 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12682 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12683 so useful that the change is worth while.
12684
12685 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12686 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12687 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12688 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12689
12690 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12691 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12692 show-paren-mode.
12693
12694 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12695 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12696 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12697
12698 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12699 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12700 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12701
12702 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12703 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12704 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12705
12706 ** Changes in View mode.
12707
12708 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12709 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12710
12711 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12712 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12713
12714 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12715 previous state.
12716
12717 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12718 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12719
12720 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12721 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12722 not just the selected window.
12723
12724 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12725 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12726 turns View mode on or off.
12727
12728 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12729 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12730 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12731
12732 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12733 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12734
12735 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12736 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12737 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12738 which version to compare with.
12739
12740 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12741 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12742
12743 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12744 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12745 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12746 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12747
12748 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12749 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12750 blocks, all of them or none.
12751
12752 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12753 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12754 confirmation first.
12755
12756 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12757 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12758 However, the mode will not be changed if
12759 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12760 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12761 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12762 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12763
12764 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12765
12766 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12767 these commands do not change the major mode.
12768
12769 ** M-x occur changes.
12770
12771 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12772 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12773
12774 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12775 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12776 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12777
12778 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12779 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12780 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12781 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12782 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12783
12784 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12785 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12786 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12787 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12788
12789 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12790 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12791 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12792
12793 ** Outline mode changes.
12794
12795 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12796
12797 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12798
12799 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12800 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12801 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12802 was already active.
12803
12804 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12805 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12806 get confused by it.
12807
12808 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12809 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12810
12811 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12812
12813 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12814 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12815 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12816 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12817
12818 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12819 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12820 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12821
12822 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12823 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12824 values.
12825
12826 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12827 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12828 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12829 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12830
12831 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12832 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12833 can be. The default value is 30.
12834
12835 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12836
12837 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12838 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12839 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12840 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12841 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12842 behavior.
12843
12844 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12845 compose-mail-other-frame.
12846
12847 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12848 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12849 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12850 buffer that shows the original message.
12851
12852 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12853 with separator lines around the contents.
12854
12855 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12856 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12857 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12858 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12859
12860 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12861
12862 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12863 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12864 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12865 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12866
12867 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12868 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12869 /etc/passwd.
12870
12871 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12872 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12873 /etc/passwd.
12874
12875 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12876 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12877 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12878 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12879
12880 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12881 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12882 be taken to be magic.
12883
12884 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12885 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12886 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12887
12888 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12889 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12890
12891 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12892 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12893
12894 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12895
12896 new key dired.el binding old key
12897 ------- ---------------- -------
12898 * c dired-change-marks c
12899 * m dired-mark m
12900 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12901 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12902 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12903 * u dired-unmark u
12904 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12905 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12906 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12907 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12908 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12909 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12910
12911 ** Rmail changes.
12912
12913 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12914 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12915 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12916 each time you run it.
12917
12918 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12919 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12920
12921 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12922 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12923 means to move in the opposite direction.
12924
12925 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12926 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12927
12928 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12929 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12930 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12931 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12932 for output.
12933
12934 ** Gnus changes.
12935
12936 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12937
12938 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12939 Gnus.
12940
12941 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12942 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12943
12944 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12945 article mode line.
12946
12947 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12948
12949 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12950
12951 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12952
12953 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12954 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12955 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12956
12957 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12958
12959 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12960
12961 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12962 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12963
12964 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12965 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12966 used to pick articles.
12967
12968 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12969 another have been added.
12970
12971 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12972
12973 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12974 generating lines in buffers.
12975
12976 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12977 `C-M-_'.
12978
12979 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12980
12981 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12982
12983 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12984
12985 *** Scores can be decayed.
12986
12987 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12988
12989 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12990 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12991
12992 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12993 the native server.
12994
12995 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12996
12997 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12998 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12999
13000 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
13001
13002 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
13003 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
13004
13005 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
13006 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
13007
13008 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
13009 a group.
13010
13011 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
13012 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
13013
13014 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
13015
13016 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
13017
13018 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
13019
13020 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
13021
13022 Use the `Y c' command.
13023
13024 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
13025
13026 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
13027
13028 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
13029
13030 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
13031 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
13032
13033 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
13034
13035 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
13036
13037 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
13038 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
13039
13040 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
13041
13042 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
13043 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
13044 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
13045 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
13046 this issue.)
13047
13048 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
13049 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
13050 particular news group. This can be done by:
13051
13052 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
13053
13054 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
13055 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
13056 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
13057 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
13058 for reading and posting).
13059
13060 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
13061 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
13062 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
13063 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
13064 there.
13065
13066 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
13067 default. Here are some of these default settings:
13068
13069 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
13070 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
13071 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
13072 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
13073 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
13074
13075 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
13076 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
13077
13078 ** CC mode changes.
13079
13080 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
13081 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
13082 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
13083 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
13084 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
13085 loaded.
13086
13087 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
13088 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
13089 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
13090 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
13091 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
13092 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13093
13094 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13095 of the current buffer.
13096
13097 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13098 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13099 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13100
13101 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13102 style that the Python developers like.
13103
13104 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13105 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13106 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13107
13108 ** VC Changes [new]
13109
13110 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13111 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13112 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13113
13114 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13115 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13116 developers.
13117
13118 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13119 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13120
13121 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13122 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13123 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13124 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13125
13126 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13127 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13128
13129 ** Calendar changes.
13130
13131 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13132 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13133 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13134 following/previous years.
13135
13136 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13137 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13138 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13139 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13140 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13141 supposed attribute of God.
13142
13143 ** ps-print changes
13144
13145 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13146 layout.
13147
13148 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13149
13150 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13151 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13152 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13153 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13154
13155 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13156 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13157 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13158
13159 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13160 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13161
13162 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13163 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13164 printing for your printer.
13165
13166 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13167 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13168
13169 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13170 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13171
13172 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13173 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13174 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13175 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13176 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13177 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13178 The default value is nil.
13179
13180 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13181 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13182
13183 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13184 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13185 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13186 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13187 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13188 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13189 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13190
13191 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13192 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13193
13194 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13195 The default is 0 ("black").
13196
13197 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13198 The default is 0 ("black").
13199
13200 border-width Specify the border width.
13201 The default is 0.4.
13202
13203 Any other property is ignored.
13204
13205 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13206 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13207 documentation).
13208
13209 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13210 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13211 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13212 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13213 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13214 controlling headers.
13215
13216 *** Color management (subgroup)
13217
13218 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13219 color.
13220
13221 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13222
13223 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13224 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13225 background should be used. Valid values are:
13226
13227 t always use face background color.
13228 nil never use face background color.
13229 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13230
13231 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13232
13233 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13234 sheet of paper.
13235
13236 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13237 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13238
13239 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13240 each page.
13241
13242 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13243 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13244 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13245
13246 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13247 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13248 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13249
13250 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13251 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13252 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13253
13254 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13255 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13256 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13257
13258 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13259 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13260 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13261
13262 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13263
13264 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13265
13266 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13267 RGB color.
13268
13269 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13270 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13271 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13272
13273 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13274 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13275 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13276 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13277 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13278 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13279 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13280 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13281 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13282 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13283 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13284 10 + 10 +
13285 11 + 11 +
13286 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13287 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13288 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13289 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13290 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13291 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13292 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13293 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13294 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13295 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13296 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13297 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13298 22 + 22 +
13299 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13300
13301 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13302
13303
13304 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13305
13306 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13307 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13308 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13309 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13310 to "-P".
13311
13312 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13313 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13314 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13315
13316 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13317 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13318 do so.
13319
13320 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13321
13322 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13323 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13324 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13325 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13326 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13327 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13328 `setpagedevice'.
13329
13330 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13331 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13332 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13333
13334 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13335 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13336 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13337 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13338 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13339 its TO, are ignored.
13340
13341 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13342 pages. Valid values are:
13343
13344 nil print all pages.
13345
13346 `even-page' print only even pages.
13347
13348 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13349
13350 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13351 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13352 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13353 print only the even sheet of paper.
13354
13355 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13356 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13357 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13358 only the odd sheet of paper.
13359
13360 Any other value is treated as nil.
13361
13362 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13363 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13364 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13365
13366 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13367
13368 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13369 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13370
13371 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13372 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13373 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13374 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13375 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13376 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13377 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13378
13379 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13380 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13381 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13382 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13383 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13384 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13385 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13386
13387 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13388
13389 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13390 messages should be sent.
13391
13392 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13393 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13394 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13395
13396 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13397
13398 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13399 points for line numbers.
13400
13401 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13402 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13403
13404 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13405 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13406 to 2, the printing will look like:
13407
13408 1 one line
13409 one line
13410 3 one line
13411 one line
13412 5 one line
13413 one line
13414 ...
13415
13416 Valid values are:
13417
13418 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13419 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13420 is used.
13421
13422 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13423 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13424
13425 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13426
13427 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13428 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13429 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13430 3, the output will look like:
13431
13432 one line
13433 one line
13434 3 one line
13435 one line
13436 one line
13437 6 one line
13438 one line
13439 one line
13440 9 one line
13441 one line
13442 ...
13443
13444 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13445 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13446
13447 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13448 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13449 `ps-font-size').
13450
13451 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13452 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13453 `ps-font-size').
13454
13455 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13456
13457 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13458 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13459
13460 ** hideshow changes.
13461
13462 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13463 C++, ; for lisp).
13464
13465 *** Support for java-mode added.
13466
13467 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13468 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13469
13470 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13471 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13472 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13473
13474 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13475 robust and a lot faster.
13476
13477 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13478
13479 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13480 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13481 documentation for more details.
13482
13483 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13484
13485 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13486 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13487 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13488 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13489 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13490
13491 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13492 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13493 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13494 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13495
13496 ** Font Lock mode
13497
13498 *** Custom support
13499
13500 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13501 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13502 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13503 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13504 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13505 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13506
13507 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13508
13509 *** Maximum decoration
13510
13511 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13512 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13513 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13514 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13515 to get the old behavior.
13516
13517 *** New support
13518
13519 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13520
13521 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13522 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13523
13524 *** Configurable support
13525
13526 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13527 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13528 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13529 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13530 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13531 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13532 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13533
13534 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13535 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13536 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13537
13538 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13539
13540 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13541 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13542 for any mode.
13543
13544 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13545
13546 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13547
13548 in your ~/.emacs.
13549
13550 *** New faces
13551
13552 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13553 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13554 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13555 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13556
13557 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13558
13559 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13560 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13561 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13562
13563 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13564
13565 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13566 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13567 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13568 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13569 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13570 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13571 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13572
13573 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13574 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13575 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13576 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13577 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13578 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13579
13580 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13581
13582 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13583 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13584 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13585 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13586
13587 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13588 settings.
13589
13590 ** Ada mode changes.
13591
13592 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13593 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13594 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13595 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13596 stubs.
13597
13598 *** There are two new commands:
13599 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13600 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13601
13602 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13603 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13604 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13605
13606 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13607 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13608 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13609
13610 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13611 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13612 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13613 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13614
13615 ** Scheme mode changes.
13616
13617 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13618 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13619 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13620 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13621 have any effect.
13622
13623 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13624 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13625 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13626 variables as buffer-local variables.
13627
13628 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13629 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13630
13631 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13632
13633 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13634 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13635 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13636 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13637
13638 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13639 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13640 buffer in Emacs.
13641
13642 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13643 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13644 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13645 option takes precedence.
13646
13647 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13648 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13649 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13650
13651 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13652 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13653 the current defun.
13654
13655 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13656 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13657
13658 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13659 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13660 necessary).
13661
13662 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13663 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13664 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13665 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13666 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13667 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13668
13669 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13670 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13671 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13672 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13673
13674 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13675 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13676 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13677 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13678 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13679
13680 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13681 since it applies only to the current frame.
13682
13683 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13684 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13685 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13686
13687 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13688 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13689 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13690 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13691 instead of just the file you are editing.
13692
13693 ** RefTeX mode
13694
13695 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13696 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13697 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13698 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13699 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13700
13701 C-c ( reftex-label
13702 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13703 knows which kind of label is needed.
13704
13705 C-c ) reftex-reference
13706 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13707 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13708
13709 C-c [ reftex-citation
13710 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13711 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13712
13713 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13714 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13715
13716 C-c = reftex-toc
13717 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13718 can quickly jump to every section.
13719
13720 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13721 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13722 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13723 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13724 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13725
13726 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13727
13728 *** Info documentation is now available.
13729
13730 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13731 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13732
13733 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13734 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13735
13736 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13737 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13738
13739 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13740 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13741 appropriate functions.
13742
13743 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13744 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13745
13746 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13747 been cleaned.
13748
13749 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13750 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13751
13752 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13753 shall be delimited.
13754
13755 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13756 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13757 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13758
13759 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13760 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13761 prefixed with `ALT'.
13762
13763 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13764 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13765 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13766 documentation).
13767
13768 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13769 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13770 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13771
13772 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13773 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13774
13775 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13776 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13777 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13778
13779 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13780
13781 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13782
13783 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13784 from alien sources.
13785
13786 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13787 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13788 crossref entries.
13789
13790 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13791 region.
13792
13793 *** Added support for imenu.
13794
13795 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13796 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13797 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13798 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13799
13800 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13801 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13802
13803 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13804
13805 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13806
13807 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13808 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13809 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13810 as an argument.
13811
13812 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13813 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13814
13815 ** browse-url changes
13816
13817 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13818 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13819 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13820 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13821 customization variables.
13822
13823 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13824
13825 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13826 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13827 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13828
13829 ** Changes in Ediff
13830
13831 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13832 pops up the Info file for this command.
13833
13834 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13835 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13836 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13837 directories).
13838
13839 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13840 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13841 files in the same directory.
13842
13843 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13844 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13845 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13846
13847 ** Changes in Viper
13848
13849 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13850 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13851 instead of vip-.
13852 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13853 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13854 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13855 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13856 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13857 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13858 color when Viper is in insert state.
13859 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13860 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13861 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13862
13863 ** Etags changes.
13864
13865 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13866 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13867 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13868 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13869 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13870
13871 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13872
13873 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13874 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13875
13876 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13877 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13878 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13879
13880 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13881 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13882 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13883 methods and protocols.
13884
13885 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13886 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13887 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13888 paragraph name.
13889
13890 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13891 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13892 at least M times and as many as N times.
13893
13894 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13895 in files has changed slightly.
13896
13897 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13898 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13899 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13900 with old time-stamp-format values.
13901
13902 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13903 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13904 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13905 reasons.
13906
13907 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13908 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13909 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13910 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13911 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13912 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13913
13914 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13915 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13916 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13917
13918 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13919 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13920 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13921 recommended now will continue to work then.
13922
13923 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13924 details.
13925
13926 ** There are some additional major modes:
13927
13928 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13929 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13930 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13931
13932 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13933 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13934 into Emacs.
13935
13936 ** New Lisp packages include:
13937
13938 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13939
13940 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13941 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13942
13943 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13944
13945 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13946 in shell buffers.
13947
13948 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13949 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13950 and `elint-defun'.
13951
13952 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13953 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13954 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13955 strings or comments.
13956
13957 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13958 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13959 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13960 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13961 at these points.
13962
13963 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13964 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13965
13966 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13967 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13968
13969 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13970
13971 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13972 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13973
13974 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13975
13976 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13977
13978 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13979
13980 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13981 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13982
13983 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13984 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13985 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13986 original place after inserting the copy.
13987
13988 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13989 on the buffer.
13990
13991 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13992 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13993 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13994
13995 Enable mouse-drag with:
13996 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13997 -or-
13998 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13999
14000 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
14001 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
14002
14003 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
14004 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
14005
14006 *** ogonek
14007
14008 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
14009 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
14010 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
14011 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
14012 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
14013 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
14014 instance) and vice versa.
14015
14016 To use this package load it using
14017 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
14018 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
14019 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
14020 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
14021 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
14022 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
14023
14024 *** Interface to ph.
14025
14026 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
14027
14028 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
14029 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
14030 these servers.
14031
14032 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
14033
14034 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
14035 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
14036 while the real cursor does not move.
14037
14038 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
14039 for visiting your favorite web sites.
14040
14041 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
14042 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
14043
14044 ** movemail change
14045
14046 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
14047 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
14048 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
14049 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
14050
14051 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
14052 \f
14053 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
14054
14055 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
14056
14057 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
14058 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
14059 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
14060 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
14061 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
14062
14063 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
14064 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
14065 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
14066 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
14067 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
14068 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
14069 \f
14070 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
14071
14072 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
14073 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
14074 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
14075 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
14076
14077 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
14078 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
14079
14080 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
14081 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
14082 "win".
14083
14084 ** Basic Lisp changes
14085
14086 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
14087 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
14088
14089 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
14090 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
14091 or by the user.
14092
14093 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14094
14095 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14096
14097 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14098 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14099
14100 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14101 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14102 its argument.
14103
14104 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14105
14106 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14107
14108 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14109
14110 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14111 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14112 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14113 `format' function.
14114
14115 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14116 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14117 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14118
14119 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14120 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14121 adding one of these suffixes.
14122
14123 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14124 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14125 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14126
14127 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14128 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14129
14130 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14131
14132 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14133 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14134
14135 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14136 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14137
14138 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14139
14140 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14141 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14142
14143 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14144 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14145 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14146 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14147
14148 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14149 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14150 of the last form.
14151
14152 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14153 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14154 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14155 as the last form.
14156
14157 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14158 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14159 matches.
14160
14161 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14162
14163 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14164 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14165 Then it returns that string.
14166
14167 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14168
14169 (with-output-to-string
14170 (princ "The buffer is ")
14171 (princ (buffer-name)))
14172
14173 returns "The buffer is foo".
14174
14175 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14176 is non-nil.
14177
14178 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14179 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14180 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14181
14182 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14183 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14184
14185 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14186 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14187 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14188 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14189 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14190 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14191
14192 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14193 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14194 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14195 characters".
14196
14197 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14198 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14199 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14200 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14201 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14202
14203 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14204 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14205 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14206 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14207
14208 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14209 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14210
14211 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14212
14213 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14214 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14215 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14216 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14217 guaranteed.
14218
14219 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14220 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14221 character).
14222
14223 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14224
14225 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14226 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14227 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14228 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14229 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14230
14231 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14232
14233 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14234 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14235 more than the number of characters.
14236
14237 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14238 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14239 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14240 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14241 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14242 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14243
14244 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14245 and returns a string containing those characters.
14246
14247 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14248 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14249 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14250 character, sref signals an error.
14251
14252 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14253 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14254 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14255
14256 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14257 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14258 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14259
14260 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14261 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14262 to a vector of the characters in it.
14263
14264 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14265 of a string. You call it as follows:
14266
14267 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14268
14269 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14270 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14271 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14272 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14273 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14274
14275 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14276 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14277
14278 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14279 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14280
14281 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14282 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14283 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14284 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14285
14286 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14287
14288 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14289
14290 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14291 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14292 are not included in the resulting value.
14293
14294 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14295 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14296 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14297 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14298
14299 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14300 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14301 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14302 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14303 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14304 column START-COLUMN.
14305
14306 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14307 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14308 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14309 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14310 changed text, before the change.
14311
14312 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14313 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14314 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14315
14316 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14317
14318 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14319
14320 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14321 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14322
14323 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14324 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14325 which identify the character within that character set.
14326
14327 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14328 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14329 opposite of split-char.
14330
14331 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14332 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14333
14334 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14335 of all the characters in a string.
14336
14337 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14338 and specifying coding systems.
14339
14340 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14341 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14342 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14343 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14344 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14345 as what to do about code conversion.)
14346
14347 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14348 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14349
14350 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14351 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14352 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14353
14354 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14355 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14356 to match against a file name.
14357
14358 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14359 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14360 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14361 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14362 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14363 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14364
14365 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14366 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14367
14368 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14369 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14370
14371 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14372 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14373 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14374 service names.
14375
14376 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14377 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14378 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14379 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14380 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14381 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14382
14383 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14384 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14385
14386 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14387 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14388 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14389 start the subprocess.
14390
14391 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14392 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14393 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14394 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14395 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14396
14397 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14398 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14399 subprocess.
14400
14401 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14402 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14403 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14404 connection permanently or until overridden.
14405
14406 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14407 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14408 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14409 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14410 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14411 system for one operation at a time.
14412
14413 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14414 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14415
14416 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14417 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14418 The value is a cons cell,
14419 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14420 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14421 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14422 input to the subprocess.
14423
14424 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14425 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14426
14427 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14428 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14429 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14430
14431 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14432 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14433 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14434 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14435 customization.
14436
14437 Thus, instead of writing
14438
14439 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14440 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14441
14442 you would now write this:
14443
14444 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14445 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14446 :type 'boolean
14447 :group foo)
14448
14449 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14450 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14451 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14452 for a description of them.
14453
14454 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14455 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14456
14457 (defgroup ispell nil
14458 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14459 :group 'processes)
14460
14461 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14462 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14463 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14464 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14465 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14466
14467 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14468 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14469 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14470 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14471 first-level subgroups.
14472
14473 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14474
14475 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14476 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14477
14478 ** easy-mmode
14479
14480 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14481 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14482 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14483 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14484 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14485 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14486
14487 ** Text property changes
14488
14489 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14490 text property.
14491
14492 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14493 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14494 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14495 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14496 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14497
14498 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14499 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14500 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14501 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14502
14503 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14504 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14505 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14506
14507 ** Changes in invisibility features
14508
14509 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14510 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14511 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14512 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14513 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14514 make the overlay visible.
14515
14516 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14517 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14518 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14519 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14520 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14521 t when it should hide it.
14522
14523 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14524
14525 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14526 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14527 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14528 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14529 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14530 Here is an example of how to do this:
14531
14532 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14533 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14534 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14535 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14536
14537 ...
14538 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14539
14540 ...
14541 ;; When done with the overlays:
14542 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14543 ;; Or respectively:
14544 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14545
14546 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14547
14548 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14549 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14550 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14551 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14552
14553 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14554 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14555 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14556
14557 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14558 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14559
14560 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14561 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14562
14563 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14564 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14565 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14566
14567 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14568 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14569 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14570 determine the syntax type of the character.
14571
14572 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14573 of the current buffer.
14574
14575 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14576 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14577 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14578
14579 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14580 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14581 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14582 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14583 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14584
14585 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14586 text property.
14587
14588 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14589 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14590 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14591
14592 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14593 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14594 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14595 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14596 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14597
14598 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14599 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14600 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14601
14602 ** Changes in face features
14603
14604 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14605 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14606
14607 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14608 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14609
14610 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14611 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14612
14613 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14614 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14615
14616 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14617 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14618 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14619 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14620 overlay property).
14621
14622 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14623 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14624
14625 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14626
14627 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14628 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14629 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14630 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14631
14632 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14633 begins with ~.
14634
14635 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14636 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14637
14638 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14639 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14640
14641 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14642 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14643
14644 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14645 character code conversion as well as other things.
14646
14647 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14648 (formerly it did not).
14649
14650 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14651 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14652
14653 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14654 instead of constant strings.
14655
14656 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14657 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14658 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14659
14660 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14661 in the same way as before.
14662
14663 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14664 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14665 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14666
14667 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14668 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14669 else, and returns nil.
14670
14671 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14672 directory cannot be listed.
14673
14674 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14675
14676 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14677 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14678 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14679 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14680 ways:
14681
14682 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14683 It is available through the history command M-n.
14684
14685 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14686 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14687 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14688 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14689 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14690
14691 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14692 argument in this way.
14693
14694 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14695 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14696 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14697
14698 ** Echo area features
14699
14700 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14701 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14702 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14703 after the echo area is cleared.
14704
14705 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14706 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14707
14708 ** Keyboard input features
14709
14710 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14711 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14712
14713 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14714 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14715 by keyboard macros.
14716
14717 ** Frame-related changes
14718
14719 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14720 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14721 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14722
14723 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14724 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14725 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14726
14727 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14728 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14729 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14730 in the selected frame.
14731
14732 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14733 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14734 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14735
14736 ** X Windows features
14737
14738 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14739 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14740 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14741
14742 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14743 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14744
14745 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14746 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14747 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14748
14749 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14750 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14751
14752 ** Subprocess features
14753
14754 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14755 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14756 automatically.
14757
14758 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14759 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14760
14761 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14762 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14763
14764 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14765 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14766
14767 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14768 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14769 goes after the other menu items.
14770
14771 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14772 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14773 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14774 are in use.
14775
14776 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14777 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14778
14779 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14780 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14781 form.
14782
14783 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14784 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14785 but its hook is still run.
14786
14787 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14788 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14789
14790 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14791 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14792 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14793
14794 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14795 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14796 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14797 warned.
14798
14799 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14800 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14801
14802 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14803 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14804 functions like display-time.
14805
14806 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14807 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14808
14809 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14810 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14811 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14812
14813 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14814 if there is an error in compilation.
14815
14816 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14817 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14818 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14819 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14820
14821 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14822 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14823 the *scratch* buffer.
14824
14825 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14826 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14827 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14828 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14829
14830 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14831 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14832 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14833
14834 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14835 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14836 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14837 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14838
14839 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14840 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14841 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14842
14843 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14844 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14845 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14846 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14847 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14848 files at all.
14849
14850 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14851 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14852 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14853 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14854
14855 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14856 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14857 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14858 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14859
14860 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14861
14862 ** imenu.el changes.
14863
14864 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14865 item from menu created by imenu.
14866
14867 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14868 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14869 select one of those items.
14870 \f
14871 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14872
14873 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14874 Copyright information:
14875
14876 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14877 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14878
14879 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14880 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14881 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14882 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14883
14884 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14885 of this document, or of portions of it,
14886 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14887 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14888 \f
14889 Local variables:
14890 mode: outline
14891 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14892 end:
14893
14894 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793